blob: 72c4680b1b6f3814fd0de3446fe540a88dd762b0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100856Three other directives are provided to report some status:
857
858 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
859 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
860 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
861
862Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
863"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
864fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
865provide advice to the user.
866
867Example:
868
869 .if "${A}"
870 .if "${B}"
871 .notice "A=1, B=1"
872 .elif "${C}"
873 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
874 .elif "${D}"
875 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
876 .else
877 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
878 .endif
879 .else
880 .notice "A=0"
881 .endif
882
883
8842.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200885----------------
886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100887Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100888values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
889otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
890numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
891for every keyword. Supported units are :
892
893 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
894 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
895 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
896 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
897 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
898 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
899
900
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009012.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200902-------------
903
904 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
905 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
906 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
907 global
908 daemon
909 maxconn 256
910
911 defaults
912 mode http
913 timeout connect 5000ms
914 timeout client 50000ms
915 timeout server 50000ms
916
917 frontend http-in
918 bind *:80
919 default_backend servers
920
921 backend servers
922 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
923
924
925 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
926 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
927 global
928 daemon
929 maxconn 256
930
931 defaults
932 mode http
933 timeout connect 5000ms
934 timeout client 50000ms
935 timeout server 50000ms
936
937 listen http-in
938 bind *:80
939 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
940
941
942Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
943
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100944 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200945
946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009473. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200948--------------------
949
950Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
951are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
952of them have command-line equivalents.
953
954The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
955
956 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200957 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200960 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200961 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200962 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200963 - description
964 - deviceatlas-json-file
965 - deviceatlas-log-level
966 - deviceatlas-separator
967 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900968 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - gid
970 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100971 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200972 - h1-case-adjust
973 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100974 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100975 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100976 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200977 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200978 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200979 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100980 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100982 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100983 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200984 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200986 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200987 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100988 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200990 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100991 - presetenv
992 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993 - uid
994 - ulimit-n
995 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200996 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100997 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100998 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200999 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001001 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001002 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001003 - ssl-default-bind-options
1004 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001005 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001006 - ssl-default-server-options
1007 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001008 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001009 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001010 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001011 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001012 - 51degrees-data-file
1013 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001014 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001015 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001016 - wurfl-data-file
1017 - wurfl-information-list
1018 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001019 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001020 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001021
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001022 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001023 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001024 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001026 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001027 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001028 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001029 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001030 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001031 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001032 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001034 - noepoll
1035 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001036 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001037 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001038 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001039 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001040 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001041 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001042 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001043 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001044 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001045 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001046 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001047 - tune.buffers.limit
1048 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001049 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001050 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001051 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001052 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001053 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001054 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001055 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001056 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001057 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001058 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001059 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001060 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001061 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001062 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001063 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1064 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001065 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001066 - tune.maxaccept
1067 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001068 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001069 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001070 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001071 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1072 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001073 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1074 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001075 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001076 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001077 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001078 - tune.sndbuf.client
1079 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001080 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001081 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001082 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001083 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001084 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001085 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001086 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001087 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001088 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001089 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001090 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1091 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1092 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001093 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1094 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001097 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001098 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099
1100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102------------------------------------
1103
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001104ca-base <dir>
1105 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001106 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1107 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1108 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110chroot <jail dir>
1111 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1112 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1113 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1114 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1115 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001116 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001117
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001118cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1119 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1120 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1121 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1122 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1123 set. These sets have the format
1124
1125 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1126
1127 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001128 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001129 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1130 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001131 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1132 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001133 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1134 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1135 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1136 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1137 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1138 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1139 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1140 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1141 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1142 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001143
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001144 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1145 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1146 on the machine's word size.
1147
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001148 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001149 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1150 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1151 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1152 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1153 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1154 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001155
1156 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001157 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1158
1159 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1160 # first 4 CPUs
1161
1162 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1163 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1164 # word size.
1165
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001166 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001167 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001168 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1169 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1170 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1171
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001172 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1173 # and so on.
1174 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1175 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1176 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1177
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001178 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001179 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1180 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1181 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1182
1183 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1184 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1185 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1186
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1188 # and a thread range.
1189 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1190 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1191 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1192
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001193crt-base <dir>
1194 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001195 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1196 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001197
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001198daemon
1199 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1200 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001201 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1202 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001204default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1205 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1206 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1207 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1208 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1209 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1210 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1211 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1212 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1213 not start with a slash ('/'):
1214 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1215 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1216
1217 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1218 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1219 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1220 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1221 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1222 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1223 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1224 each of them.
1225
1226 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1227 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1228 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1229 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1230 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1231 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1232 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1233 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1234
1235 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1236 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1237 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1238 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1239 made easily relocatable.
1240
1241 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1242 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1243 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1244 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1245 consistent across all configuration files.
1246
1247 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1248 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1249 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1250 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1251 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1252 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1253 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1254 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1255
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001256deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1257 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001258 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001259
1260deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001261 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001262 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1263
1264deviceatlas-separator <char>
1265 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1266 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1267
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001268deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001269 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1270 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1271 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001272
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001273external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001274 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1275 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001276 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1277 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1278 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1279 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1280 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001281
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001282gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001283 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001284 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1285 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001286 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1287 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001288 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001289
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001290group <group name>
1291 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1292 See also "gid" and "user".
1293
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001294hard-stop-after <time>
1295 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1296
1297 Arguments :
1298 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1299 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1300 SIGUSR1 signal.
1301
1302 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1303 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1304 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1305
1306 Example:
1307 global
1308 hard-stop-after 30s
1309
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001310h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1311 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1312 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1313 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1314 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001315 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001316 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1317 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1318 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1319 specified in a proxy.
1320
1321 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1322 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1323 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1324 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1325 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1326 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1327 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1328
1329 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1330 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1331 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1332 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1333 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1334
1335 Example:
1336 global
1337 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1338
1339 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1340 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1341
1342h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1343 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1344 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1345 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1346 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1347 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1348 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1349 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1350 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1351
1352 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1353 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1354 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1355
1356 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1357 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1358
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001359insecure-fork-wanted
1360 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1361 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1362 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1363 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1364 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1365 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1366 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1367 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1368 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1369 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1370 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1371 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1372 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1373 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1374 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1375 disable it.
1376
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001377insecure-setuid-wanted
1378 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1379 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1380 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1381 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1382 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1383 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1384 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1385 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1386 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1387 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1388 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1389 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1390 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1391 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1392
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001393issuers-chain-path <dir>
1394 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1395 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1396 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1397 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1398 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1399 "issuers-chain-path".
1400 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1401 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1402 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1403 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1404 will share the chain in memory.
1405
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001406localpeer <name>
1407 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1408 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1409 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1410 the configuration parsing.
1411
1412 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1413 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1414
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001415log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001416 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001417 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001418 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001419 configured with "log global".
1420
1421 <address> can be one of:
1422
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001423 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001424 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1425 port).
1426
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001427 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1428 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1429 port).
1430
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001431 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001432 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1433 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001434 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001435
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001436 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1437 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1438 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1439 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1440 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1441 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1442 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1443 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1444 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1445 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1446 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1447 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1448 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1449 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001450 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1451 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001452
1453 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1454 "fd@2", see above.
1455
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001456 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1457 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1458 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1459 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1460 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001462 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1463 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001464
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001465 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1466 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1467 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1468 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1469 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1470 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1471 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1472 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1473 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1474 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001475 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1476 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001477
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001478 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1479 one of the following :
1480
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001481 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1482 field is stripped. This is the default.
1483 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1484 rfc3164.
1485
1486 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001487 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1488
1489 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1490 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1491
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001492 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1493 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1494 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1495 designed to be used with a local log server.
1496
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001497 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1498 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1499 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1500 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1501 logger consumes.
1502
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001503 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1504 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1505 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1506 used with a local log server.
1507
1508 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1509 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1510 designed to be used with a local log server.
1511
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001512 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1513 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1514 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1515 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1516
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001517 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1518 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1519 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1520 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1521 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1522
1523 <sample_size>
1524 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1525 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1526 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1527 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1528 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1529
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001530 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001531
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001532 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1533 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1534 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1535
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001536 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1537 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1538 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1539 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
1541 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001542 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1543 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1544 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1545 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1546 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1547 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001549 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001550
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001551log-send-hostname [<string>]
1552 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1553 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1554 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1555 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1556 the logs.
1557
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001558log-tag <string>
1559 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1560 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1561 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001562 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001563
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001564lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001565 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1566 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1567 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1568 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1569 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1570 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001571 used multiple times.
1572
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001573lua-load-per-thread <file>
1574 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1575 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1576 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1577 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1578 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1579 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1580 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1581 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1582 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1583 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1584 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1585 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1586 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1587 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1588 times.
1589
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001590lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1591 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1592 variable.
1593 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1594 to "path".
1595
1596 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1597 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1598 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1599 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1600 will be checked earlier.
1601
1602 As an example by specifying the following path:
1603
1604 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1605 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1606
1607 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1608 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1609 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1610 paths if that does not exist either.
1611
1612 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1613 documentation.
1614
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001615master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001616 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1617 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1618 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001620 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1621 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001622 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1623 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1624 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1625 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1626 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001627
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001628 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001629
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001630mworker-max-reloads <number>
1631 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001632 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001633 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1634 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1635 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1636
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001637nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001638 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1639 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1640 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001641 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1642 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001643 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1644 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1645 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001646
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001647nbthread <number>
1648 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001649 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1650 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1651 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1652 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1653 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001654 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1655 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1656 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1657 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1658 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1659 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1660 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001661
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001662numa-cpu-mapping
1663 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1664 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1665 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1666 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1667 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1668 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1669 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1670 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1671 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001673pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001674 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1675 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1676 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1677 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001678
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001679pp2-never-send-local
1680 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1681 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1682 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1683 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1684 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1685 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1686 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1687 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1688 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1689 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1690 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1691
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001692presetenv <name> <value>
1693 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1694 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1695 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1696 and "unsetenv".
1697
1698resetenv [<name> ...]
1699 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1700 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1701 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1702 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1703 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1704 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1705 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1706 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1707
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001708stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001709 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1710 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1711 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1712 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1713 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1714 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001715 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001716 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1717 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1718 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1719 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001720
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001721server-state-base <directory>
1722 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001723 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1724 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001725
1726server-state-file <file>
1727 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1728 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1729 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1730 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1731 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1732 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1733 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1734 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001735 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1736 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001737
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001738set-var <var-name> <expr>
1739 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1740 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1741 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1742 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1743 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1744 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1745 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1746 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1747 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1748
1749 Example:
1750 global
1751 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1752 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1753 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1754
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001755setenv <name> <value>
1756 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1757 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1758 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1759 and "unsetenv".
1760
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001761set-dumpable
1762 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001763 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1764 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1765 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1766 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1767 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1768 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1769 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1770 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1771 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1772 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1773 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1774 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1775 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1776 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1777 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1778 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1779 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001780
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001781ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1783 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001784 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001785 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001786 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1787 information and recommendations see e.g.
1788 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1789 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1790 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1791 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001792
1793ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1795 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1796 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1797 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1798 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001799 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1800 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1801 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001802 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001803
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001804ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1806 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1807 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1808 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1809 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1810
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001811ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1813 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1814 keyword to see available options.
1815
1816 Example:
1817 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001818 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001819
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001820ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1822 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001823 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001824 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001825 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1826 information and recommendations see e.g.
1827 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1828 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1829 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1830 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1831 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001832
1833ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1835 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1836 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1837 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1838 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001839 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1840 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1841 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1842 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001843
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001844ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1846 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1847 keyword to see available options.
1848
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001849ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1851 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1852 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001853 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001854 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001855 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1856 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1857 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1858 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001859 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1860 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1861 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1862
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001863ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1864 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1865 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001866 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001867 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001868 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1869
1870 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001871
1872 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1873 and won't try to remove them.
1874
1875 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1876
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001877ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001878 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001879 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1880 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001881
1882 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1883 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1884 optimize the startup time.
1885
1886 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1887 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1888 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1889
1890 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001891 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001892
1893 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001894 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1895
1896 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1897 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1898 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1899 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1900 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1901 bind configuration..
1902
1903 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1904 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1905 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1906 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1907 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1908 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1909 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1910 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1911
1912 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1913
1914 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1915 a cert bundle.
1916
1917 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1918 separately in several "crt".
1919
1920 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1921 since files are loading separately.
1922
1923 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1924 required to commit them.
1925
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001926 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001927 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001928
1929 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1930
1931 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1932
1933 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1934 not provided in the PEM file.
1935
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001936 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1937 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1938
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001939 The default behavior is "all".
1940
1941 Example:
1942 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1943 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1944 ssl-load-extra-files none
1945
1946 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1947
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001948ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1949 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1950 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1951 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1952
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001953ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001954 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001955 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1956 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1957 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1958 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1959 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1960 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001961 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001962
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001963stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1964 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1965 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1966 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001967 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001968 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001969
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001970 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1971 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1972 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001973
1974stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1975 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1976 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001977 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001978
1979stats maxconn <connections>
1980 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1981 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1982
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001984 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001985 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1986 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1987 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1988
1989ulimit-n <number>
1990 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1991 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1992 option.
1993
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001994unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1995 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1996
1997 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1998 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1999 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2000 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2001 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
2002 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
2003 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2004 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2005 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2006 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2007
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002008unsetenv [<name> ...]
2009 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2010 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2011 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2012 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2013 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2014 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2015 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2016
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017user <user name>
2018 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2019 See also "uid" and "group".
2020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002021node <name>
2022 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2023
2024 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2025 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2026 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2027 traffic.
2028
2029description <text>
2030 Add a text that describes the instance.
2031
2032 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2033 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2034 "<" and ">" characters.
2035
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100203651degrees-data-file <file path>
2037 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002038 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002039
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002040 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002041 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2042
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000204351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002044 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2045 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2046 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2047
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002048 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002049 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2050
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200205151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002052 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2053 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2054
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002055 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2056 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2057
205851degrees-cache-size <number>
2059 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2060 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2061 By default, this cache is disabled.
2062
2063 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002064 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2065
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002066wurfl-data-file <file path>
2067 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2068 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2069
2070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2071 with USE_WURFL=1.
2072
2073wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2074 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2075 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2076 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2077
2078 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2079
2080 Valid WURFL properties are:
2081 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2082
2083 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2084 device.
2085
2086 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2087 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2088
2089 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2090 particular web request.
2091
2092 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2093 used Libwurfl API version.
2094
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002095 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2096 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2097
2098 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2099 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2100
2101 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2102
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002103 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2104 with USE_WURFL=1.
2105
2106wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2107 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2108 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2109
2110 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2111 with USE_WURFL=1.
2112
2113wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2114 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2115 thus before the chroot.
2116
2117 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2118 with USE_WURFL=1.
2119
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002120wurfl-cache-size <size>
2121 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2122 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002123 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002124 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002125
2126 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2127 with USE_WURFL=1.
2128
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002129strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002130 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2131 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2132 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2133 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2134 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021363.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002137-----------------------
2138
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002139busy-polling
2140 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2141 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2142 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2143 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2144 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2145 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2146 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2147 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2148 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2149 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2150 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2151 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2152 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2153 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2154 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2155 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2156 "poll" pollers.
2157
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002158 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2159 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2160 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2161
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002162max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2163 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2164 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2165 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2166 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2167 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2168 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2169 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2170 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2171
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002172maxconn <number>
2173 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2174 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2175 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002176 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2177 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2178 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2179 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002180 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2181 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2182 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2183 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2184 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2185 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002187maxconnrate <number>
2188 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2189 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2190 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2191 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2192 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2193 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2194 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2195 fairness.
2196
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002197maxcomprate <number>
2198 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002199 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002200 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2201 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2202 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002203 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002204 default value.
2205
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002206maxcompcpuusage <number>
2207 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2208 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2209 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2210 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2211 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2212 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2213 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2214 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2215
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002216maxpipes <number>
2217 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2218 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2219 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2220 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2221 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2222 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2223
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002224maxsessrate <number>
2225 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2226 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2227 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2228 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2229 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2230 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2231 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2232 fairness.
2233
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002234maxsslconn <number>
2235 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2236 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2237 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2238 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2239 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2240 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2241 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002242 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2243 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2244 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2245 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2246 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2247 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2248 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002249
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002250maxsslrate <number>
2251 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2252 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2253 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2254 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2255 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2256 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2257 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2258 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2259 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2260 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2261
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002262maxzlibmem <number>
2263 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2264 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2265 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002266 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2267 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2268 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2269
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002270noepoll
2271 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2272 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002273 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002274
2275nokqueue
2276 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2277 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2278 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2279
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002280noevports
2281 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2282 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2283 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2284 also "nopoll".
2285
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002286nopoll
2287 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2288 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002290 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2291 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002292
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002293nosplice
2294 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002295 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002296 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002297 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002298 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2299 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2300 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2301 "option splice-response".
2302
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002303nogetaddrinfo
2304 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2305 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2306
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002307noreuseport
2308 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2309 command line argument "-dR".
2310
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002311profiling.memory { on | off }
2312 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2313 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2314 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2315 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2316 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2317 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2318 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2319 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2320 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2321
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002322profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2323 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2324 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2325 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2326 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002327 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002328 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2329 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2330 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2331 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2332
2333 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2334 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2335 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2336 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2337 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002338 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2339 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2340 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2341 CLI.
2342
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002343spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002344 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2345 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2346 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2347 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2348 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2349 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002351ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002352 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002353 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002354 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2355 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2356 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2357 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2358 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002359 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2360 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002361 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2362 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2363 openssl configuration file uses:
2364 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2365
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002366ssl-mode-async
2367 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002368 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002369 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2370 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2371 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002372 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002373 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002374
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002375tune.buffers.limit <number>
2376 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2377 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2378 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2379 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2380 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002381 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002382 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2383 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2384 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2385 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2386 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2387 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2388 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2389 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2390 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2391
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002392tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2393 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2394 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2395 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2396 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2397
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002398tune.bufsize <number>
2399 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2400 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2401 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2402 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2403 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2404 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2405 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002406 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2407 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2408 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002409 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002410 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2411 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2412 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002413
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002414tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2415 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002416
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002417tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2418 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2419 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2420 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2421 this value. The default value is 1.
2422
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002423tune.fail-alloc
2424 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2425 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2426 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2427 gracefully.
2428
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002429tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2430 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2431 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2432 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2433 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2434 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2435
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002436tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2437 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2438 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2439 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2440 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2441 change it.
2442
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002443tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2444 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002445 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2446 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002447 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2448 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2449 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2450 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2451 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2452
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002453tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2454 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2455 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2456 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2457 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2458 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2459 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2460 recommended not to change this value.
2461
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002462tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2463 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2464 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2465 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2466 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2467 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2468 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2469 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2470
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002471tune.http.cookielen <number>
2472 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2473 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2474 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2475 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2476 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2477 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2478 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2479 to change this value.
2480
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002481tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002482 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2483 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002484 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002485 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002486 configuration directives too.
2487 The default value is 1024.
2488
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002489tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2490 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2491 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2492 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2493 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2494 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2495 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002496 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2497 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2498 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002499
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002500tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2501 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2502 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2503 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2504 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2505 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2506 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002507 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2508 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2509 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2510 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2511 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002512
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002513tune.idletimer <timeout>
2514 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2515 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2516 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2517 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2518 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2519 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002520 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002521 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002522 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2523
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002524tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2525 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2526 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2527 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2528 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2529 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2530 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2531 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2532 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2533 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2534
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002535tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2536 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002537 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002538 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2539 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002540 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002541 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2542 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2543
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002544tune.lua.maxmem
2545 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2546 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2547 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2548 memory.
2549
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002550tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2551 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002552 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2553 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002554 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002555
2556tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2557 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2558 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2559 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2560 check servers.
2561
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002562tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2563 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2564 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2565 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002566 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002567
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002568tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002569 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2570 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002571 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2572 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2573 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2574 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2575 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2576 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2577 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2578 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2579 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002580
2581tune.maxpollevents <number>
2582 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2583 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2584 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2585 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2586 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2587
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002588tune.maxrewrite <number>
2589 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2590 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2591 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2592 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2593 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2594 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2595 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2596 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2597 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2598 bufsize.
2599
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002600tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2601 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2602 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2603 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2604 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2605 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2606 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2607 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2608 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2609 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002610 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2611 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002612 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2613 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2614 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2615 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2616 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2617 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2618 setting this parameter to 0.
2619
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002620tune.pipesize <number>
2621 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2622 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2623 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2624 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2625 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2626 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2627
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002628tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2629 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2630 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2631 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2632 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2633 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2634 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002635 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002636
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002637tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2638 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2639 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2640 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2641 default is 20.
2642
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002643tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2644tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2645 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2646 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2647 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002648 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002649 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002650 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2651 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2652
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002653tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002654 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002655 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2656 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2657 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2658 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2659
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002660tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002661 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002662 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2663 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2664 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2665 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2666 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2667 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2668 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002669
2670tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2671 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2672 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2673 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2674 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2675 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2676 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2677 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2678 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2679 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002680
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002681tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2682tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2683 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2684 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2685 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002686 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002687 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002688 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2689 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2690 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2691 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2692 notifying haproxy again.
2693
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002694tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002695 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002696 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2697 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2698 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2699 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2700 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2701 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2702 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2703 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2704 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2705 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2706 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002707
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002708tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002709 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002710 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2711 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2712 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2713 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2714 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2715
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002716tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2717 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2718 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2719 performances. This is disabled by default.
2720
2721 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2722 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2723
2724 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2725
2726 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2727
2728 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2729
2730 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2731 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2732 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2733
2734 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2735 converted.
2736
2737 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2738 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2739 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2740 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2741 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2742 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2743 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002744 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2745 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002746
2747 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2748
2749 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2750 only need this line:
2751
2752 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2753
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002754tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2755 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002756 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002757 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2758 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2759 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2760 being used for too long.
2761
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002762tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2763 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2764 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2765 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2766 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2767 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2768 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2769 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2770 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2771 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2772 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002773 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002774 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002775
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002776tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2777 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2778 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2779 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2780 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002781 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002782 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2783 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002784 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2785 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002786
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002787tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2788 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2789 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2790 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2791 1000 entries.
2792
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002793tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2794 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2795 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2796 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2797
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002798tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002799tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002800tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2801tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2802tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002803 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2804 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2805 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2806 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2807 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2808 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2809 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2810 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002811
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002812 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2813 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2814 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2815 all available space is consumed.
2816 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2817 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2818 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002819
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002820tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2821 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002822 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002823 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002825 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2826
2827tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2828 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2829 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002830 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2831 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028333.3. Debugging
2834--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002835
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002836quiet
2837 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2838 line argument "-q".
2839
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002840zero-warning
2841 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2842 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2843 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2844 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2845 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2846 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2847
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028493.4. Userlists
2850--------------
2851It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2852http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2853it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2854
2855userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002856 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002857 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2858
2859group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002860 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002861 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2862 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2863
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002864user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2865 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002866 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2867 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002868 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2869 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2870 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2871 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002872
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002873 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2874 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2875 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2876 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2877 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2878 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2879 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2880 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2881 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002882
2883 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002884 userlist L1
2885 group G1 users tiger,scott
2886 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002887
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002888 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2889 user scott insecure-password elgato
2890 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002891
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002892 userlist L2
2893 group G1
2894 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002895
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002896 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2897 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2898 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002899
2900 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002901
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002902
29033.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002904----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002905It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2906several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2907instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2908values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2909automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2910In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2911using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2912tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2913reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2914Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2915that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2916each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002917
2918peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002919 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002920 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2921
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002922bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2923 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2924 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2925
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002926disabled
2927 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2928 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2929 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2930
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002931default-bind [param*]
2932 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2933
2934default-server [param*]
2935 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2936
2937 Arguments:
2938 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2939 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2940 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2941 details.
2942
2943
2944 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2945
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002946enable
2947 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2948
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002949log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002950 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2951 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2952 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2953 more details.
2954
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002955peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002956 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2957 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002958 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2959 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2960 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2961 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2962 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002963
2964 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2965 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2966
2967 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002968 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2969 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2970 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002971
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002972 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2973 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002974
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002975 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2976 "server" keyword explanation below).
2977
2978server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002979 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002980 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2981 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2982 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2983 of this "peers" section).
2984 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2985
2986
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002987 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002988 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002989 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002990 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2991 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2992 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002993
2994 backend mybackend
2995 mode tcp
2996 balance roundrobin
2997 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2998 stick on src
2999
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003000 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3001 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003002
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003003 Example:
3004 peers mypeers
3005 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3006 default-server ssl verify none
3007 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3008 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003009
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003010
3011table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3012 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3013
3014 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3015 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003016 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003017 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3018 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3019 "stick-table" keyword).
3020
3021 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3022 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3023 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3024 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3025 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3026 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3027 of the stick-table name as follows:
3028
3029 peers mypeers
3030 peer A ...
3031 peer B ...
3032 table t1 ...
3033
3034 frontend fe1
3035 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3036
3037 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3038 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3039
3040 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3041 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3042 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3043 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3044 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3045 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3046 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3047
3048 peers mypeers
3049 peer A ...
3050 peer B ...
3051 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3052
3053 backend t1
3054 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3055
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003056 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003057 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3058 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3059
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030603.6. Mailers
3061------------
3062It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3063If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3064in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3065
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003066mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003067 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3068 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3069
3070mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3071 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3072
3073 Example:
3074 mailers mymailers
3075 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3076 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3077
3078 backend mybackend
3079 mode tcp
3080 balance roundrobin
3081
3082 email-alert mailers mymailers
3083 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3084 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3085
3086 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3087 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3088
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003089timeout mail <time>
3090 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3091 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3092 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3093 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3094
3095 Example:
3096 mailers mymailers
3097 timeout mail 20s
3098 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003099
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031003.7. Programs
3101-------------
3102In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3103master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3104managed the same way as the workers.
3105
3106During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3107sequence as a worker:
3108
3109 - the master is re-executed
3110 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3111 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3112 instance of the program
3113
3114During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3115
3116program <name>
3117 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3118 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3119 the management guide).
3120
3121command <command> [arguments*]
3122 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3123 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3124 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3125 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3126
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003127user <user name>
3128 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3129 See also "group".
3130
3131group <group name>
3132 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3133 See also "user".
3134
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003135option start-on-reload
3136no option start-on-reload
3137 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3138 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3139 program section.
3140
3141
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031423.8. HTTP-errors
3143----------------
3144
3145It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3146imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3147several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3148
3149http-errors <name>
3150 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3151 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3152
3153errorfile <code> <file>
3154 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3155
3156 Arguments :
3157 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003158 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003159 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003160
3161 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3162 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3163 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3164 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3165 before any chroot is performed.
3166
3167 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3168
3169 Example:
3170 http-errors website-1
3171 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3172 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3173 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3174
3175 http-errors website-2
3176 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3177 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3178 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3179
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031803.9. Rings
3181----------
3182
3183It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3184servers or traces.
3185
3186ring <ringname>
3187 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3188
3189description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003190 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003191 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3192
3193format <format>
3194 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3195
3196 Arguments:
3197 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3198 one of the following :
3199
3200 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3201 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3202 designed to be used with a local log server.
3203
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003204 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3205 field is stripped. This is the default.
3206 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3207 rfc3164.
3208
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003209 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3210 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3211 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3212 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3213 is the default.
3214
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003215 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003216 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3217
3218 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3219 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3220
3221 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3222 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3223 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3224 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3225 logger consumes.
3226
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003227 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3228 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3229 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3230 with a local log server.
3231
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003232 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3233 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3234 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3235 used with a local log server.
3236
3237maxlen <length>
3238 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3239 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3240 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3241
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003242server <name> <address> [param*]
3243 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3244 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3245 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3246 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3247 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3248 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3249 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3250 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3251 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003252 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3253 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003254
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003255size <size>
3256 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3257 set to BUFSIZE.
3258
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003259timeout connect <timeout>
3260 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3261
3262 Arguments :
3263 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3264 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3265 as explained at the top of this document.
3266
3267timeout server <timeout>
3268 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3269
3270 Arguments :
3271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3273 as explained at the top of this document.
3274
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003275 Example:
3276 global
3277 log ring@myring local7
3278
3279 ring myring
3280 description "My local buffer"
3281 format rfc3164
3282 maxlen 1200
3283 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003284 timeout connect 5s
3285 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003286 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003287
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032883.10. Log forwarding
3289-------------------
3290
3291It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3292haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3293
3294log-forward <name>
3295 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3296
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003297backlog <conns>
3298 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3299 on connections accept.
3300
3301bind <addr> [param*]
3302 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003303 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3304 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3305 syslog protocol over TCP.
3306 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003307 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3308
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003309dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003310 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3311 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3312 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3313 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003314 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003315
3316log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003317log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003318 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3319 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3320 documentation.
3321 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3322 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3323 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3324 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3325 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3326
3327 Example:
3328 global
3329 log stderr format iso local7
3330
3331 ring myring
3332 description "My local buffer"
3333 format rfc5424
3334 maxlen 1200
3335 size 32764
3336 timeout connect 5s
3337 timeout server 10s
3338 # syslog tcp server
3339 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3340
3341 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003342 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3343 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003344 # all messages on stderr
3345 log global
3346 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3347 log ring@myring local0
3348 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3349 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3350 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3351 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3352 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003353
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003354maxconn <conns>
3355 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3356 10 is the default.
3357
3358timeout client <timeout>
3359 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033614. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003362----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003364Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003365 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3366 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3367 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3368 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003369
3370A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3371connections.
3372
3373A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3374to forward incoming connections.
3375
3376A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3377parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3378
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003379A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3380ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3381sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3382the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3383explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3384from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3385"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3386for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3387to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3388optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3389are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3390any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3391names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3392that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3393duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3394names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3395
3396Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3397settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3398of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3399profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3400timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003402All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3403'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3404case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3405
3406Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3407logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3408proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3409However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3410name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3411
3412Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3413and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003414bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003415protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3416modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3417arbitrary criteria.
3418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003419In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3420a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003421the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003422
3423 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3424 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3425 between responses and new requests.
3426
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003427 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3428 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3429 client-facing connection remains open.
3430
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003431 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3432 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003433
3434The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3435frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3436following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003437weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003438
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003439 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003440
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003441 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3442 ----+-----+-----+----
3443 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3444 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003445 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3446 ----+-----+-----+----
3447 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003448
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003449It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3450only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3451into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3452as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3453content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3454and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3455possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003457There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3458first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3459processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3460second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3461protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3462is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3463new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3464to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3465process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3466already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3467HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3468evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3469one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3470
3471There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3472performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3473tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3474preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3475analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3476HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3477header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3478mitigate this drawback.
3479
3480It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3481method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3482set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3483in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3484is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3485to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3486above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3487to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3488"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3489frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3490frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3491as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3492upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3493on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3494the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3495upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3496frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3497remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034994.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3500--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003502The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3503limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3504they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3505limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003506marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003507option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003508and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3509with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3510specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003512
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003513 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3514------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3515acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003516backlog X X X -
3517balance X - X X
3518bind - X X -
3519bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003520capture cookie - X X -
3521capture request header - X X -
3522capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003523clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3524clitcpka-idle X X X -
3525clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003526compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003527cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003528declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529default-server X - X X
3530default_backend X X X -
3531description - X X X
3532disabled X X X X
3533dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003534email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003535email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003536email-alert mailers X X X X
3537email-alert myhostname X X X X
3538email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003539enabled X X X X
3540errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003541errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003542errorloc X X X X
3543errorloc302 X X X X
3544-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3545errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003546force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003547filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003548fullconn X - X X
3549grace X X X X
3550hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003551http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003552http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003553http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003554http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003555http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003556http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003557http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003558http-check set-var X - X X
3559http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003560http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003561http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003562http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003563http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003564http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003566ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003567load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003568log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003569log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003570log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003571log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003572max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003573maxconn X X X -
3574mode X X X X
3575monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576monitor-uri X X X -
3577option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3578option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3579option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3580option allbackups (*) X - X X
3581option checkcache (*) X - X X
3582option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3583option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003584option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3586option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003587-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3588option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003589option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3590option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003591option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003592option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003593option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003594option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003595option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3597option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3598option httpchk X - X X
3599option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003600option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003601option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003602option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003603option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003604option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3606option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3607option logasap (*) X X X -
3608option mysql-check X - X X
3609option nolinger (*) X X X X
3610option originalto X X X X
3611option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003612option pgsql-check X - X X
3613option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003615option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616option smtpchk X - X X
3617option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3618option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3619option splice-request (*) X X X X
3620option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003621option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3623option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3624-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003625option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003626option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3627option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3628option tcpka X X X X
3629option tcplog X X X X
3630option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003631external-check command X - X X
3632external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3634rate-limit sessions X X X -
3635redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003638retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003640server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003641server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003642source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003643srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3644srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3645srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003646stats admin - X X X
3647stats auth X X X X
3648stats enable X X X X
3649stats hide-version X X X X
3650stats http-request - X X X
3651stats realm X X X X
3652stats refresh X X X X
3653stats scope X X X X
3654stats show-desc X X X X
3655stats show-legends X X X X
3656stats show-node X X X X
3657stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003658-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3659stick match - - X X
3660stick on - - X X
3661stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003662stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003663stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003664tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003665tcp-check connect X - X X
3666tcp-check expect X - X X
3667tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003668tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003669tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003670tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003671tcp-check set-var X - X X
3672tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003673tcp-request connection - X X -
3674tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003675tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003676tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003677tcp-response content - - X X
3678tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003679timeout check X - X X
3680timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003681timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003682timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003683timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3684timeout http-request X X X X
3685timeout queue X - X X
3686timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003687timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003688timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003689timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003691unique-id-format X X X -
3692unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003694use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003695use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3697 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003698
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037004.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3701---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003702
3703This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3704
3705
3706acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3707 Declare or complete an access list.
3708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3709 no | yes | yes | yes
3710 Example:
3711 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3712 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3713 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003715 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003716
3717
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003718backlog <conns>
3719 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | no
3722 Arguments :
3723 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3724 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003725 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003726
3727 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3728 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3729 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3730 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3731 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3732 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3733 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3734 backlog parameter.
3735
3736 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3737 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3738 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3739
3740 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3741
3742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003743balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003744balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003745 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | no | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3750 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3751 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3752 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3753
3754 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3755 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3756 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3757 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003758 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003759 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003760 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3761 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3762 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3763 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3764 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3765 it, so that you don't worry.
3766
3767 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3768 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3769 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3770 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3771 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3772 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3773 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3774 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003776 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3777 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3778 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3779 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3780 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3781 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3782 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003783 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3784 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3785 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003786
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003787 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003788 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003789 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3790 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003791 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003792 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3793 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3794 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3795 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3796 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003797 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3798 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3799 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3800 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3801 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3802 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003804 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3805 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3806 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3807 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3808 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3809 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3810 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3811 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003812 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003814 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3815 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3816 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003817
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003818 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3819 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3820 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3821 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3822 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3823 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3824 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3825 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3826 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3827 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3828 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3829 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003831 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003832 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3833 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3834 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3835 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3836 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3837 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3838 URIs start with a leading "/".
3839
3840 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3841 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3842 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3843 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3844
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003845 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3846 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3847 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3848 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3849
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003850 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003851 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3852
3853 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003854 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3855 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003856 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3857 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3858 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3859 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003860 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003861 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3862 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003863
3864 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3865 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3866 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3867 server will receive the request.
3868
3869 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3870 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3871 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3872 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3873 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003874 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3875 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3876 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003878 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3879 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3880 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3881 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3882 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003884 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003885 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3886 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3887 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3888
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003889 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3890 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3891 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3892
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003893 random
3894 random(<draws>)
3895 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003896 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3897 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3898 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3899 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003900 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3901 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3902 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3903 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3904 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3905 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3906 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3907 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3908 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3909 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3910 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3911 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3912 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3913 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3914 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3915 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3916 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3917 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3918 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3919 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003920
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003921 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003922 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003923 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3924 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3925 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3926 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3927 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3928 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003929 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003930 used instead.
3931
3932 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3933 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3934 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3935 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3936
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003937 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3938 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3939 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3940
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003941 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003944 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3945 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003946
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003947 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3948 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3949 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003951 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003952 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003953 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3954 NTLM relies on.
3955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956 Examples :
3957 balance roundrobin
3958 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003959 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003960 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3961 balance hdr(host)
3962 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003963
3964 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3965 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003967 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003968 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3969 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3970 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003971 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003972
3973 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3974 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3975 defaults to 16 kB.
3976
3977 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3978 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3979
3980 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3981 Round Robin.
3982
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003983 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003984 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3985 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3986 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3987
3988 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3989
3990 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003991 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003992 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3993 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3994 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003995
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003996 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003997
3998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003999bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4000bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004001 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 no | yes | yes | no
4004 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004005 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4006 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4007 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4008 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004009 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004010 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4011 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4012 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4013 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4014 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4015 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004016 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004017 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4018 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004019 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004020 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4021 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004022 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004023 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4024 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004025 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004026 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4027 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4028 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4029 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4030 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4031 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4032 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004033 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4034 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4035 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004036 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4037 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4038 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4039 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004040 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4041 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4042 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004043
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004044 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4045 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004046 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4047 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4048 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004049 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4050 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4051 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4052 the range.
4053
4054 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4055 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4056 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4057 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4058 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4059 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4060 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004061 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004062 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004063
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004064 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004065 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004066 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4067 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4068 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4069 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4070 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4071 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4072
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004073 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4074 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4075 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4076 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004078 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4079 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4080 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4081 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4082 in a frontend.
4083
4084 Example :
4085 listen http_proxy
4086 bind :80,:443
4087 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004088 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004089
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004090 listen http_https_proxy
4091 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004092 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004093
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004094 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4095 bind ipv6@:80
4096 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4097 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4098
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004099 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004100 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004101
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004102 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4103 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4104 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4105 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4106 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4107
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004108 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004109 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004110
4111
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004112bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004113 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | yes | yes | yes
4116 Arguments :
4117 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4118 may be used to override a default value.
4119
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004120 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004121 option may be combined with other numbers.
4122
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004123 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004124 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4125 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4126 missing from all processes.
4127
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004128 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004129 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004130 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4131 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4132 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4133 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4134 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004135 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004136
4137 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4138 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4139 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4140 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4141 and 'even' instances.
4142
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004143 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4144 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4145 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4146 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004147
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004148 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4149 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4150
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004151 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4152 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4153 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4154
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004155 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4156 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4157
4158 Example :
4159 listen app_ip1
4160 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004161 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004162
4163 listen app_ip2
4164 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004165 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004166
4167 listen management
4168 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004169 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004170
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004171 listen management
4172 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4173 bind-process 1-4
4174
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004175 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176
4177
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004178capture cookie <name> len <length>
4179 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 no | yes | yes | no
4182 Arguments :
4183 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4184 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4185 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4186 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004187 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188
4189 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4190 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4191 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4192 right if it exceeds <length>.
4193
4194 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4195 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4196 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4197 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4198
4199 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4200 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4201 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4202
4203 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4204 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4205 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004206 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4207 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4208 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209
4210 Example:
4211 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4212
4213 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004214 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215
4216
4217capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004218 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4220 no | yes | yes | no
4221 Arguments :
4222 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004223 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4225 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4226 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4227
4228 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4229 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4230 it exceeds <length>.
4231
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004232 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004233 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4234 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004235 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4236 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4237 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4238 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004239 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004240 environments to find where the request came from.
4241
4242 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4243 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4244 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4245 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004246
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004247 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4248 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4249 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4250 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4251 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004252
4253 Example:
4254 capture request header Host len 15
4255 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004256 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004258 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004259 about logging.
4260
4261
4262capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004263 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4265 no | yes | yes | no
4266 Arguments :
4267 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004268 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004269 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4270 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4271 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4272
4273 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4274 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4275 it exceeds <length>.
4276
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004277 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4279 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4280 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004281 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4282 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4283 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4284 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004286 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4287 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4288 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4289 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4290 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291
4292 Example:
4293 capture response header Content-length len 9
4294 capture response header Location len 15
4295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004296 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004297 about logging.
4298
4299
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004300clitcpka-cnt <count>
4301 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4302 the connection on the client side.
4303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4304 yes | yes | yes | no
4305 Arguments :
4306 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4307
4308 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4309 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004310 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4311 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004312
4313 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4314
4315
4316clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4317 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4318 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4319 client side.
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 yes | yes | yes | no
4322 Arguments :
4323 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4324 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4325 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4326 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4327
4328 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4329 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004330 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4331 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004332
4333 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4334
4335
4336clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4337 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | no
4340 Arguments :
4341 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4342 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4343 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4344 document.
4345
4346 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4347 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004348 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4349 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004350
4351 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4352
4353
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004354compression algo <algorithm> ...
4355compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004356compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004357 Enable HTTP compression.
4358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | yes | yes | yes
4360 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004361 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4362 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4363 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4364
4365 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004366 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4367 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4368 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004369
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004370 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004371 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004372
4373 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4374 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4375 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4376 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4377 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004378 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004379
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004380 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4381 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4382 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4383 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4384 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4385 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4386 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004387 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004388
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004389 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004390 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004391 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4392 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4393 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4394 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4395 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004396
4397 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4398 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4399 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4400 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4401 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004402 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4403 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4404 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4405 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4406 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004407 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4408 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004409
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004410 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004411 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4412 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004413 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004414 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004415 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4416 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4417 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4418 "multipart"
4419 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4420 header
4421 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4422 and later
4423 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4424 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004425 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004426
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004427 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004428
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004429 Examples :
4430 compression algo gzip
4431 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004432
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004433
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004434cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004435 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4436 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004437 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004438 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4440 yes | no | yes | yes
4441 Arguments :
4442 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4443 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4444 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4445 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4446 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4447 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004448 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004449 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4450 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4451
4452 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4453 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4454 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4455 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4456 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4457 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004458 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4459 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004460 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004461 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4462 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
4464 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004465 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004466
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004467 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004468 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004469 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004470 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004471 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4472 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4473 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4474 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4475 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4476 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4477 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004478
4479 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4480 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4481 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4482 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4483 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4484 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4485 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4486 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4487 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004488 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004489 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4490 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4491 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004492
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004493 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4494 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4495 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004496 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4497 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4498 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4499 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004500 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4501 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4502 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004503
4504 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4505 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4506 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4507 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4508 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4509 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4510 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4511 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4512 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4513
4514 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4515 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4516 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4517 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4518 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4519 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4520 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4521 persistence cookie in the cache.
4522 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4523
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004524 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4525 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4526 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4527 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4528 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004529 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004530 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4531 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4532 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4533 they logout.
4534
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004535 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4536 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4537 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4538 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4539
4540 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4541 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4542 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4543 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4544 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4545 this attribute.
4546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004547 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004548 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004549 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4550 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4551 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4552 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4553 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4554 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004555
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004556 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4557 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4558 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4559 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4560 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4561 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4562 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4563 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004564 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004565 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4566 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4567 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4568 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4569 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4570 the site.
4571
4572 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4573 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4574 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4575 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4576 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4577 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4578 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4579 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4580 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4581 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4582 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4583 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4584 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004585 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004586 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4587 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4588
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004589 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4590 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4591 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4592 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4593 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4594 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4595
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004596 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4597 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4598 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4599 repeated.
4600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004601 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4602 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4603 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4604 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606 Examples :
4607 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4608 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4609 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004610 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004612 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004613
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004614
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004615declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4616 Declares a capture slot.
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 no | yes | yes | no
4619 Arguments:
4620 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4621
4622 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4623 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4624 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4625 for use in the response.
4626
4627 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004628 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004629 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4630
4631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004632default-server [param*]
4633 Change default options for a server in a backend
4634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 yes | no | yes | yes
4636 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004637 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4638 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4639 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4640 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004641
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004642 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004643 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4644
4645 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004646
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004648default_backend <backend>
4649 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 yes | yes | yes | no
4652 Arguments :
4653 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4654
4655 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4656 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4657 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4658 will catch all undetermined requests.
4659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004660 Example :
4661
4662 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4663 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4664 default_backend dynamic
4665
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004666 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004669description <string>
4670 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4672 no | yes | yes | yes
4673 Arguments : string
4674
4675 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4676 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4677 it describes.
4678 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4679
4680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004681disabled
4682 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | yes | yes | yes
4685 Arguments : none
4686
4687 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4688 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4689 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4690 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4691 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4692 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4693 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4694
4695 See also : "enabled"
4696
4697
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004698dispatch <address>:<port>
4699 Set a default server address
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004702 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004703
4704 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4705 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4706 during start-up.
4707
4708 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4709 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4710 possible with normal servers.
4711
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004712 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004713 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4714 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4715 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4716 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4717
4718 See also : "server"
4719
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004720
4721dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4722 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 yes | no | yes | yes
4725 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4726
4727 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004728 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004729 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4730 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004731 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004732 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734enabled
4735 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4737 yes | yes | yes | yes
4738 Arguments : none
4739
4740 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4741 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4742
4743 See also : "disabled"
4744
4745
4746errorfile <code> <file>
4747 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | yes | yes | yes
4750 Arguments :
4751 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004752 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004753 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004754
4755 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004756 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004757 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004758 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4759 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004760
4761 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4762 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4763 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4764
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004765 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4766
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004767 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4768 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4769 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4770 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4771 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4772 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4773 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4774 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4775 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004777 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4778 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4779 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004780 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004781 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4782
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004783 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004784
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004785 Example :
4786 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004787 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004788 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4789 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4790
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004791
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004792errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4793 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4794 section.
4795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 yes | yes | yes | yes
4797 Arguments :
4798 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4799
4800 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004801 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004802 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4803 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004804
4805 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4806 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4807 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4808 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4809 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004810 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004811 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4812
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004813 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4814 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004815
4816 Example :
4817 errorfiles generic
4818 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4819
4820
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821errorloc <code> <url>
4822errorloc302 <code> <url>
4823 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4825 yes | yes | yes | yes
4826 Arguments :
4827 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004828 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004829 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830
4831 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4832 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4833 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4834 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004835 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004836
4837 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4838 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4839 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4840
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004841 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4842
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4844 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4845 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4846 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004847 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004848 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4849 request.
4850
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004851 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852
4853
4854errorloc303 <code> <url>
4855 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | yes
4858 Arguments :
4859 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004860 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004861 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004862
4863 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4864 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4865 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4866 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004867 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004868
4869 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4870 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4871 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4872
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004873 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4876 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4877 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4878 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004879 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004880
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004881 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004882
4883
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004884email-alert from <emailaddr>
4885 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004886 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889
4890 Arguments :
4891
4892 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4893
4894 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4895 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4896
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004897 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004898 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4899 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004900
4901
4902email-alert level <level>
4903 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4904 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | yes | yes | yes
4907
4908 Arguments :
4909
4910 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4911 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4912 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4913
4914 By default level is alert
4915
4916 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4917 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4918 for the proxy.
4919
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004920 Alerts are sent when :
4921
4922 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4923 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4924 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4925 is notice or lower
4926 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4927 and a health check status update occurs
4928
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004929 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4930 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004931 section 3.6 about mailers.
4932
4933
4934email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4935 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4937 yes | yes | yes | yes
4938
4939 Arguments :
4940
4941 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4942
4943 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4944 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4945
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004946 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4947 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004948
4949
4950email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4951 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4952 mailers.
4953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 yes | yes | yes | yes
4955
4956 Arguments :
4957
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004958 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004959
4960 By default the systems hostname is used.
4961
4962 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4963 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4964 for the proxy.
4965
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004966 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4967 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004968
4969
4970email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004971 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004972 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | yes | yes | yes
4975
4976 Arguments :
4977
4978 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4979
4980 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4981 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4982
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004983 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004984 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4985
4986
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004987force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4988 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004990 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004991
4992 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4993 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4994 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4995 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4996 marked down for maintenance operations.
4997
4998 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4999 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5000 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5001 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5002 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5003 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5004 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5005 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5006 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5007
5008 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5009 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5010 is used.
5011
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005012 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005013 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005014
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005015
5016filter <name> [param*]
5017 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5019 no | yes | yes | yes
5020 Arguments :
5021 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5022 referenced in section 9.
5023
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005024 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005025 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005026 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5027 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005028
5029 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5030 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5031
5032 Example:
5033 listen
5034 bind *:80
5035
5036 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5037 filter compression
5038 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5039
5040 compression algo gzip
5041 compression offload
5042
5043 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5044
5045 See also : section 9.
5046
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005047
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005048fullconn <conns>
5049 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5051 yes | no | yes | yes
5052 Arguments :
5053 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5054 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5055
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005056 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005057 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005058 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005059 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5060 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5061 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5062 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5063 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005064 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005065
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005066 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5067 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005068 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5069 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5070 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005072 Example :
5073 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5074 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5075 # connections.
5076 backend dynamic
5077 fullconn 10000
5078 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5079 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5080
5081 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5082
5083
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005084grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005085 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005087 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005088 Arguments :
5089 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5090 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5091 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5092
5093 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5094 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005095 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005096 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5097
5098 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5099 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5100 simplify it.
5101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005102
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005103hash-balance-factor <factor>
5104 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5106 yes | no | no | yes
5107 Arguments :
5108 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5109 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005110 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005111
5112 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5113 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5114 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5115 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5116 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5117 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5118 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5119
5120 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5121 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5122 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5123 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5124 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5125
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005126 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5127 consistent hashing mechanism.
5128
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005129 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5130
5131
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005132hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005133 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
5136 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005137 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5138 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005139
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005140 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5141 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5142 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5143 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5144 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5145 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5146 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5147 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5148 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5149 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005150
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005151 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5152 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5153 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5154 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5155 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5156 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5157 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5158 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5159 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5160 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5161 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5162 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5163 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005164 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5165 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005166
5167 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5168
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005169 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005170 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5171 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5172 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005173 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5174 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5175 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005176
5177 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5178 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005179 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5180 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5181 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5182 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5183
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005184 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5185 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5186 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5187 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5188 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5189 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5190 parameter.
5191
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005192 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5193 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5194 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5195 used on strings.
5196
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005197 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5198
5199 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5200 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5201 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5202 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5203 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5204 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5205 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5206 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5207 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5208 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5209 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5210 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005211
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005212 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5213 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5214 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005215
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005216 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005217
5218
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005219http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5220 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5221 ones).
5222
5223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 no | yes | yes | yes
5225
5226 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5227 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5228 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5229 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5230 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5231 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5232
5233 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5234 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5235 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5236
5237 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5238 below.
5239
5240 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5241 instance.
5242
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005243 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5244 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5245 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5246
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005247 Example:
5248 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5249 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5250 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5251
5252http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5253
5254 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5255 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5256 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5257 example, or to pass some internal information.
5258 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5259 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5260 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5261
5262http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5263
5264 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5265 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5266
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005267http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005268
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005269 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5270 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5271 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5272 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5273 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005274
5275http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5276 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5277
5278 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5279
5280 Example:
5281 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5282
5283 # applied to:
5284 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5285
5286 # outputs:
5287 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5288
5289 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5290
5291http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5293
5294 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5295
5296 Example:
5297 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5298
5299 # applied to:
5300 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5301
5302 # outputs:
5303 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5304
5305http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5306
5307 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5308 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5309 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5310
5311http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5313
5314 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5315 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5316 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5317 fallback.
5318
5319 Example:
5320 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5321 http-response set-status 431
5322 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5323 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5324
5325http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5328 inline.
5329
5330 Arguments:
5331 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5332 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5333 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5334 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5335 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5336 (request and response)
5337 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5338 processing
5339 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5340 processing
5341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5342 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5343 and '_'.
5344
5345 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5346 followed by some converters.
5347
5348 Example:
5349 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5350
5351http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5352
5353 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5354 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5355 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5356 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5357 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005358 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005359 processing.
5360
5361 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5362 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005363 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005364 rules evaluation.
5365
5366http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5367
5368 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5369 details about <var-name>.
5370
5371 Example:
5372 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5373
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005374
5375http-check comment <string>
5376 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5377 it fails.
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5379 yes | no | yes | yes
5380
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005381 Arguments :
5382 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5383 rule fails.
5384
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005385 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5386 user-friendly error reporting.
5387
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005388 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005389 "http-check expect".
5390
5391
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005392http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5393 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005394 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005395 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | no | yes | yes
5398
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005399 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005400 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5401
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005402 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005403 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005404
5405 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5406 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5407 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5408 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5409
5410 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5411
5412 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5413
5414 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5415
5416 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5417
5418 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5419
5420 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5421 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5422 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5423 is used.
5424
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005425 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5426 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5427 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5428 haproxy -vv.
5429
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005430 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5431
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005432 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5433 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5434 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5435 different ports or with different servers.
5436
5437 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5438 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5439 the port with a "http-check connect".
5440
5441 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5442 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5443 do.
5444
5445 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5446 unset-var or comment rules.
5447
5448 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005449 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5450 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5451 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5452 option httpchk
5453
5454 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005455 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005456 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005457 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005458 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005459 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005460
5461 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5462
5463 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005464
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005466http-check disable-on-404
5467 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005469 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005470 Arguments : none
5471
5472 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5473 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5474 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5475 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5476 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5477 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5478 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5479 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005480 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5481 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005482 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5483 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5484 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005485
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005486 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005487
5488
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005489http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005490 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5491 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5492 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005493 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005495 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005496
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005497 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005498 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5499
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005500 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5501 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5502 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5503 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5504 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5505 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5506 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5507 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5508 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5509 result is always conclusive.
5510
5511 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5512 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5513 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005514 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5515 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005516 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5517 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005518 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5519 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5520 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005521
5522 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5523 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005524 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5525 supported :
5526 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5527 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005528 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5529 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5530 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5531 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5532 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005533
5534 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5535 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005536 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5537 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5538 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5539 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005540 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5541
5542 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5543 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5544 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5545 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5546
5547 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5548 informational message reported in logs if an error
5549 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5550 log-format string.
5551
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005553 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5554 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005555 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5556 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5557 details on the supported keywords.
5558
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005559 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5560 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5561 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5562 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005563
5564 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5565 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5566 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5567 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5568 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5569
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005570 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5571 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5572 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5573 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5574 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5575 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5576 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005577
5578 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005579 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005580 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5581 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5582 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5583 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5584
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005585 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5586 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005587 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5588 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5589 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5590 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5591 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5592 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5593 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5594 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005595 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5596 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5597 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5598 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5599 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5600 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5601 insensitive on the header names.
5602
5603 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5604 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5605 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5606 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5607 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5608 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005609
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005610 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005611 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005612 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5613 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5614 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5615 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5616 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005617 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 trace).
5619
5620 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005621 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005622 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5623 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5624 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5625 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5626 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005627 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005628
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005629 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5630 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5631 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5632 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5633 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5634 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5635
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005636 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005637 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005638 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5639 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5640 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5641 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5642 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5643 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5644
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005645 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5646 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5647 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5648 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5649 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005650
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005651 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5652 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5653
5654 Examples :
5655 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005656 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005657
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005658 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5659 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5660
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005661 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005662 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005663
5664 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005665 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005666
5667 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005668 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005669
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005670 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005671 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005672
5673
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005674http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005675 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5676 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005677 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5678 health checks.
5679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 yes | no | yes | yes
5681 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005682 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5683
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005684 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5685 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5686 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5687 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5688 to invent non-standard ones.
5689
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005690 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5691 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5692 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5693 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5694
5695 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5696 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5697 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5698 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005699
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005700 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005701 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005702 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005703 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5704 to add it.
5705
5706 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5707 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5708 to the log-format rules.
5709
5710 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5711 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5712 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005713
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005714 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5715 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5716 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5717 request.
5718
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005719 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5720 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5721 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005722 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5723 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5724 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5725 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005726 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005727
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005728 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005729 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5730 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005731
5732 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5733 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5734 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5735 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5736 configured request authority.
5737
5738 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5739 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005740
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005741 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005742
5743
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005744http-check send-state
5745 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | no | yes | yes
5748 Arguments : none
5749
5750 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5751 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5752 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5753 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5754 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5755
5756 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5757 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5758 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5759 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5760 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005761 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5762 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5763 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5764
5765 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5766 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5767 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5768
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005769 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5770 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5771 checked in multiple backends.
5772
5773 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5774 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5775
5776 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5777 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5778 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5779 one fails.
5780
5781 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5782 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5783 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5784
5785 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5786 server's queue.
5787
5788 Example of a header received by the application server :
5789 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5790 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5791
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005792 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5793 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005794
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005795
5796http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005797 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | no | yes | yes
5800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005801 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005802 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5803 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5804 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5805 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5806 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5807 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5808 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5809 and '-'.
5810
5811 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5812
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005813 Examples :
5814 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005815
5816
5817http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005818 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 yes | no | yes | yes
5821
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005822 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005823 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5824 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5825 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5826 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5827 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5828 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5829 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5830 and '-'.
5831
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005832 Examples :
5833 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005835
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005836http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5837 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5838 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5839 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5840 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5842 yes | yes | yes | yes
5843 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005844 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005845 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005846 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005847 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005848
5849 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5850 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5851 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5852 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5853
5854 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5855 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5856 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5857 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5858
5859 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5860 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5861 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5862 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5863 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5864 chroot is performed.
5865
5866 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5867 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5868 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5869 considered.
5870
5871 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5872 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5873 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5874 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5875 considered as a raw string.
5876
5877 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5878 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5879 "content-type".
5880
5881 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5882 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5883 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5884 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5885 evaluated as a log-format string.
5886
5887 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5888 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5889 argument to "content-type".
5890
5891 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5892 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5893 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5894 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5895
5896 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5897 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5898 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5899 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5900 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5901 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5902 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5903 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5904
5905 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5906 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5907 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5908
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005909 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5910 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5911 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5912 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5913 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5914
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005915 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5916 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5917
5918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005919http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005920 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5921
5922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5923 no | yes | yes | yes
5924
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005925 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5926 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5927 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5928 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5929 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005931 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5932 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005933
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005934 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005935
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005936 Example:
5937 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5938 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5939 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 http-request allow if nagios
5942 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5943 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5944 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946 Example:
5947 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5948 acl add path /addacl
5949 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5954 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005956 Example:
5957 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5958 acl setmap path /setmap
5959 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005961 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005962
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005963 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5964 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005966 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5967 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005968
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005969http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005971 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5972 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5973 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5974 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5975 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5976 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5977 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5978 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5983 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5984 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5985 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5986 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5987 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5988 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5989 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005991http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5994 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005995
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6000 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6001 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6002 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6003 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006004
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006005 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6006 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6007 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6008 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6009 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6010 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6011 instead.
6012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 Example:
6014 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6015 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006016
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006017http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006018
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006019 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6025 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6026 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6027 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6028 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6029 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6030 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6031 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6032 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6035 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6036 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006037 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6038
6039 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6040 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6041 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6042 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006044http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6047 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6048 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6049 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6050 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6051 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006052
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006053http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006054
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006055 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6056 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6057 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6058 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6059 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006063 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6064 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6065 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6066 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6067 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6068 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006069
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006070http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6071http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6072 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6073 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6074 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6075 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006076
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006077 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6078 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6079 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006080 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006081 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6082 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6083 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006085 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006086
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006087http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6088 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6089 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6090 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6091
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006092http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6093
6094 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6095 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6096 pointed by <resolvers>.
6097 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6098 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6099 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6100 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6101 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6102 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6103 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6104 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6105 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6106 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6107 to 0.0.0.0.
6108
6109 Example:
6110 resolvers mydns
6111 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6112 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6113 timeout retry 1s
6114 hold valid 10s
6115 hold nx 3s
6116 hold other 3s
6117 hold obsolete 0s
6118 accepted_payload_size 8192
6119
6120 frontend fe
6121 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6122 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6123 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6124
6125 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6126 # which mean DNS resolution error
6127 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6128
6129 default_backend be
6130
6131 backend b_503
6132 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6133 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6134 # 503 error page to end users
6135
6136 backend be
6137 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6138 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6139 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6140 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6141 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6142
6143 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6144 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6145
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006146http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6147
6148 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6149 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6150 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6151 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006152 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6153 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006154
6155 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6156
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006157http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006158http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006159http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006160http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006161http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006162http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6163http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006164
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006165 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6166
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006167 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6168 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6169 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6170 processing in your infrastructure.
6171
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006172 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6173 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6174 the supported backend.
6175
6176 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6177 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6178 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6179 number of segments in the path.
6180
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006181 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6182 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6183 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6184 when improperly combined.
6185
6186 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6187 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6188 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6189 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6190 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6191
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006192 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006193
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006194 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6195 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006196
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006197 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6198 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6199
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006200 Example:
6201 - /. -> /
6202 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6203 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6204 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006205
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006206 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6207 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6208
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006209 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006210 their preceding segment.
6211
6212 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6213 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6214
6215 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6216 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006217
6218 Example:
6219 - /foo/../ -> /
6220 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6221 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6222 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006223 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006224 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006225 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006226
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006227 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6228 removed as well:
6229
6230 Example:
6231 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6232 - /bar/../../ -> /
6233
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006234 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6235 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006236
6237 Example:
6238 - // -> /
6239 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6240
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006241 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6242 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6243
6244 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6245 ".", "_", and "~".
6246
6247 Example:
6248 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6249 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6250 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6251 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6252
6253 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6254 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6255
6256 Example:
6257 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6258 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6259
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006260 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006261 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006262
6263 Example:
6264 - /%6f -> /%6F
6265 - /%zz -> /%zz
6266
6267 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6268 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6269
6270 Example:
6271 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6272
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006273 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006274 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6275 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6276
6277 Example:
6278 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6279 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6280 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006282http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006284 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6285 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6286 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6287 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6288 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006290http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006292 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6293 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6294 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6295 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006297http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6298 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006299
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006300 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006301 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6302 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6303 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6304 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6305 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006306
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006307 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6308 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6309 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6310 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6311 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006312
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006313 Example:
6314 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6315
6316 # applied to:
6317 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6318
6319 # outputs:
6320 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6321
6322 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006323
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006324 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6325
6326 # applied to:
6327 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006328
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006329 # outputs:
6330 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006331
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006332http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6333 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6334
6335 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6336 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006337 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6338 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6339 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006340
6341 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6342 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6343 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6344
6345 Example:
6346 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6347 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6348
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006349 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6350 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6351 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6352 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6353
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006354http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6356
6357 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6358 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6359 query-string are replaced.
6360
6361 Example:
6362 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6363 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6364
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006365http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6367
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006368 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6369 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6370 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6371 against.
6372
6373 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6374 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6375 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006376
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006377 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6378 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6379 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6380 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6381 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6382 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6383 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6384 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6385 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006386 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6387 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006388
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006389 Example:
6390 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6391 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006392
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006393 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6394 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6397 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006398
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006399 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6400 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6401 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6402 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006403
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006404 Example:
6405 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006406
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006407 # applied to:
6408 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006409
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006410 # outputs:
6411 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006412
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006413http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6414 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6415 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006416 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006417 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6418
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006419 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006420 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6421 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006422 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006423 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006424 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006425 are followed to create the response :
6426
6427 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6428 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6429 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6430 ignored.
6431
6432 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6433 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006434 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006435 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6436 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006437
6438 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6439 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6440 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006441 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6442 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006443
6444 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6445 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6446 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006447 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006448 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006449 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006450
6451 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6452 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6453 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6454 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6455 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6456 as a raw content.
6457
6458 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6459 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6460 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6461 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6462 considered as a raw string.
6463
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006464 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006465 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6466 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6467 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6468
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006469 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6470 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006471 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006472
6473 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6474
6475 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006476 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006477 if { path /ping }
6478
6479 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6480 if { path /favicon.ico }
6481
6482 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6483 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6484 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6487http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6490 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6491 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006492
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006493http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6494 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006495
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006496 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6497 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6498 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6499 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006501http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006503 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6504 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6505 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6506 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6507 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006509 Arguments:
6510 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6511 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 Example:
6514 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6515 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6518 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006520http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006522 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6523 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6524 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 Arguments:
6527 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6528 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530 Example:
6531 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6532 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6535 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6536 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006540 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6541 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6542 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6543 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6544 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006546 Example:
6547 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6548 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6549 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6550 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6551 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6552 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6553 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6554 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6555 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006557http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006559 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6560 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6561 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6562 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6563 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006565http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6566 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6569 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6570 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6571 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6572 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6573 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6574 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6575 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6576 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006578http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006580 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6581 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6582 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6583 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6584 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6585 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6586 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006588http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6591 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6592 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6597 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6598 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6599 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6600 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6601 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6602 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6603 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006605http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006607 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6608 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6609 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6610 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6611 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6612 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 Example :
6615 # prepend the host name before the path
6616 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006617
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006618http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6619
6620 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6621 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6622 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6627 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6628 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6629 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6630 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6635 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6636 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6637 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6638 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6639 values have higher priority.
6640 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6641 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6642 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6643 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6644 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6649 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6650 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6651 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6652 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6653 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6654 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006657
6658 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6660 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6663 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6664 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6665 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006666 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6667 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668
6669 Arguments :
6670 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6671 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006672
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006673 See also "option forwardfor".
6674
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006675 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6677 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6678
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006679 # After the masking this will track connections
6680 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6681 http-request track-sc0 src
6682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006683 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6684 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6685
6686http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6687
6688 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6689 expression.
6690
6691 Arguments:
6692 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6693 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006694
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006695 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006696 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6697 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6698
6699 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6700 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6701 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6702
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006703http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006704 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6705
6706 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6707 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6708 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6709 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6710 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6711
6712 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6713 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6714 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6715 results.
6716
6717 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006718 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6719 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006721http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6722
6723 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6724 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6725 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6726 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6727 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6728 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6729 information from the request.
6730
6731 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6732
6733http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6734
6735 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6736 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6737 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6738 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6739 path and the query string.
6740 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6741
6742http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6743
6744 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6745 inline.
6746
6747 Arguments:
6748 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6749 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6750 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6752 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6753 (request and response)
6754 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6755 processing
6756 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6757 processing
6758 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6759 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6760 and '_'.
6761
6762 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6763 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006764
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006765 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006766 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006768http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6769 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6772 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6773 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6774 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6775 agent name must be used.
6776
6777 Arguments:
6778 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6779
6780 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6781 configuration.
6782
6783http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6784
6785 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6786 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6787 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6788 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6789 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6790 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6791 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6792 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6793 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6794 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6795 action.
6796 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6797 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6798 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6799 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6800 you fully understand how it works.
6801
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006802http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6803
6804 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6805 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6806 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6807 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6808 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006809 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006810 processing.
6811
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006812 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006813 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6814 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6815 rules evaluation.
6816
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006817http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6818http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6819 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6820 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6821 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6822 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006823
6824 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6825 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6826 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006827 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6828 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6829 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6830 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6831 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6832 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6833 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6834 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6835 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6836 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006837 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006838 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6839 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6840 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6841 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6842 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006843
6844http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6845http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6847
6848 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6849 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6850 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6851 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006852 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006853 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6854 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6855 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6856 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6857 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6858 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6859 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6860
6861 Arguments :
6862 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6863 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6864 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6865 select which table entry to update the counters.
6866
6867 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6868 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6869 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6870 that table until the session ends.
6871
6872 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6873 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6874 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6875 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6876 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6877 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6878 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6879 useful information.
6880
6881 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6882 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6883 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6884 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6885 checks that make use of it.
6886
6887http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6888
6889 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006890
6891 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006892 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006893
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006894http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6895
6896 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6897 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6898 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6899 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6900 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6901 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6902
6903 Arguments :
6904 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6905
6906 Example:
6907 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6908
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006909http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6910 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6911
6912 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6913 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6914 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6915 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6916 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6917 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6918 http-buffer-request".
6919
6920 Arguments :
6921
6922 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6923 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6924
6925 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006926 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006927 bytes.
6928
6929 Example:
6930 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6931
6932 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6933
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006934http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006935
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006936 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6937 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6938 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006939
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006941http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006942 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6943
6944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6945 no | yes | yes | yes
6946
6947 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6948 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6949 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6950 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6951 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6952 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006954 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6955 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006957 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006959 Example:
6960 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006962 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006964 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6965 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006967 Example:
6968 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006972 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6973 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006975 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6976 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6981 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6982 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6983 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6984 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6985 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6986 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6987 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006989http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006991 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6992 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6993 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6994 example, or to pass some internal information.
6995 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6996 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6997 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006999http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007001 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7002 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007003
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007004http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007005
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007006 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007008http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007010 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7011 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7012 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7013 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7014 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7015 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7016 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007018 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7019 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7020 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7021 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7022 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007023
7024 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7025 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7026 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7027 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007029http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7032 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7033 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7034 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7035 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7036 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007037
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007038http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007039
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007040 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7041 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7042 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7043 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7044 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7049 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7050 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7051 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7052 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7053 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007054
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007055http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7056http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7057 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7058 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7059 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7060 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007061
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7063 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7064 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007065 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007066 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7067 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7068 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007069 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007070 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007074 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7075 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7076 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7077 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7078 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7079 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7082 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007083
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007084 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7085 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 Example:
7088 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 # applied to:
7091 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093 # outputs:
7094 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007098http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007100
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007101 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007102 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104 Example:
7105 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007107 # applied to:
7108 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110 # outputs:
7111 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007112
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007113http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7114 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7115 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007116 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007117 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7118
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007119 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007120 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7121 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007122 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007123 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007124 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007125 are followed to create the response :
7126
7127 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7128 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7129 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7130 ignored.
7131
7132 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7133 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007134 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007135 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7136 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007137
7138 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7139 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7140 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007141 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7142 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007143
7144 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7145 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7146 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007147 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007148 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007149 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007150
7151 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7152 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7153 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7154 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7155 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7156 as a raw content.
7157
7158 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7159 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7160 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7161 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7162 considered as a raw string.
7163
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007164 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7165 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7166 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7167 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7168
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007169 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7170 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007171 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007172
7173 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7174
7175 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007176 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007177 if { status eq 404 }
7178
7179 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7180 string "This is the end !" \
7181 if { status eq 500 }
7182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007183http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7184http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7187 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7188 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007189
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007190http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7191 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007192
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007193 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7194 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7195 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7196 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007198http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007200 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7201 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7202 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7203 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7204 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007206 Arguments:
7207 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007209 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7210 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007212http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007214 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7215 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7216 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7219
7220 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7221 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7222 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7223 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7224 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7225
7226http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7227
7228 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7229 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7230 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7231 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7232 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7233 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7234 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7235 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7236 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7237
7238http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7239
7240 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7241 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7242 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7243 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7244 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7245 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7246 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7247
7248http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7249
7250 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7251 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7252 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7253 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7254 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7255 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7256 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7257 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7258
7259http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7260 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7261
7262 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7263 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7264 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7265 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007266
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007267 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007268 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7269 http-response set-status 431
7270 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7271 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007273http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007275 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7276 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7277 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7278 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7279 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7280 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7281 based on some information from the request.
7282
7283 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7284
7285http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7286
7287 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7288 inline.
7289
7290 Arguments:
7291 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7292 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7293 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7294 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7295 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7296 (request and response)
7297 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7298 processing
7299 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7300 processing
7301 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7302 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7303 and '_'.
7304
7305 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7306 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007307
7308 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007309 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007311http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007313 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7314 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7315 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7316 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7317 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7318 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7319 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7320 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7321 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7322 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7323 action.
7324 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7325 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7326 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7327 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7328 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007329
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007330http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7331
7332 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7333 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7334 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7335 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7336 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007337 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007338 processing.
7339
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007340 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007341 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007342 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007343 rules evaluation.
7344
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007345http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7346http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7347http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007349 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7350 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7351 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7352 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7353 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7354 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7355
7356http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7357
7358 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7359 about <var-name>.
7360
7361 Example:
7362 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7363
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007364http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7366
7367 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7368 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7369 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7370 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7371 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7372 buffer is full.
7373
7374 Arguments :
7375
7376 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7377 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7378
7379 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007380 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007381 bytes.
7382
7383 Example:
7384 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007385
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007386http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7387 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7388
7389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 yes | no | yes | yes
7391
7392 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007393 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7394 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7395 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007396
7397 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7398
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007399 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7400 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7401 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7402 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7403 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7404 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7405 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7406 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7407 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7408 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007409
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007410 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7411 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7412 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7413 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7414 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7415 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7416 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007417 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7418 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7419 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7420 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7421 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7422 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007423
7424 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7425 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7426 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7427 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7428 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7429 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7430 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7431 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007432 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007433 downsides of rare connection failures.
7434
7435 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7436 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7437 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7438 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7439 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7440 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007441 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007442 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7443 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7444 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7445 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7446 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7447
7448 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007449 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7450 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7451 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7452 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007453
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007454 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7455 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007456
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007457 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007458
7459 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7460 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7461 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7462
7463 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7464
7465
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007466http-send-name-header [<header>]
7467 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007468 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7469 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007470 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007471 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7472
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007473 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7474 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7475 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7476 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7477 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7478 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7479 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7480 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7481 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7482 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7483 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7484 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7485 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7486 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7487 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7488 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007489
7490 See also : "server"
7491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007492id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007493 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7495 no | yes | yes | yes
7496 Arguments : none
7497
7498 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7499 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7500 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007501
7502
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007503ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7504 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007506 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007507
7508 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7509 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7510 and running).
7511
7512 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7513 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7514 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007515 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007516 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7517
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007518 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7519 "unless" condition is met.
7520
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007521 Example:
7522 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7523 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7524 ignore-persist if url_static
7525
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007526 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7527
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007528load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7529 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7531 yes | no | yes | yes
7532
7533 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7534 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7535 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007536 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007537 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7538 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7539 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7540 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7541
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007542 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007543 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007544 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007545
7546 Arguments:
7547 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7548 named "server-state-file".
7549
7550 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7551 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7552 name is used as a file name.
7553
7554 none don't load any stat for this backend
7555
7556 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007557 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7558 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7559 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007560 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007561 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007562
7563 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7564 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7565
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007566 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007567
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007568 global
7569 stats socket /tmp/socket
7570 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007571
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007572 defaults
7573 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007574
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007575 backend bk
7576 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7577 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007578
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007579
7580 Then one can run :
7581
7582 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7583
7584 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7585
7586 1
7587 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7588 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7589 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7590
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007591 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007592
7593 global
7594 stats socket /tmp/socket
7595 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7596
7597 defaults
7598 load-server-state-from-file local
7599
7600 backend bk
7601 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7602 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7603
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007604
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007605 Then one can run :
7606
7607 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7608
7609 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7610
7611 1
7612 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7613 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7614 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7615
7616 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7617 "show servers state"
7618
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007619
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007620log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007621log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007622 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007623no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007624 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7626 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007627
7628 Prefix :
7629 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7630 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7631 prefix does not allow arguments.
7632
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007633 Arguments :
7634 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7635 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7636 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7637 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7638 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7639 parameter.
7640
7641 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7642 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7643
7644 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7645 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7646 standard syslog port).
7647
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007648 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7649 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7650 standard syslog port).
7651
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007652 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7653 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7654 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007655 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007656
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007657 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7658 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7659 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7660 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7661 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7662 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7663 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7664 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7665 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7666 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7667 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7668 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7669 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7670 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7671 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7672 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007673 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7674 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007675
7676 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7677 and "fd@2", see above.
7678
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007679 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7680 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7681 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7682 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7683 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7684 having the logs instantly available.
7685
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007686 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7687 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7688 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7689
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007690 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7691 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007692
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007693 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7694 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7695 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7696 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7697 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7698 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7699 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7700 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7701 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7702 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007703 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007704
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007705 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7706 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7707 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7708 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7709 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7710
7711 <sample_size>
7712 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7713 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7714 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7715 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7716 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7717
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007718 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7719 one of the following :
7720
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007721 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7722 field is stripped. This is the default.
7723 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7724 rfc3164.
7725
7726 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007727 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7728
7729 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7730 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7731
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007732 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7733 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7734 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7735 designed to be used with a local log server.
7736
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007737 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7738 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7739 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7740 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7741 systemd logger consumes.
7742
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007743 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7744 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7745 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7746 used with a local log server.
7747
7748 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7749 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7750 designed to be used with a local log server.
7751
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007752 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7753 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7754 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7755 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7756
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007757 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7758
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007759 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7760 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7761 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7762
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007763 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7764 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7765 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7766 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007767
7768 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7769 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7770 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007771 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7772 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7773 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7774 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7775 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007776
7777 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7778
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007779 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7780 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7781 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007782
7783 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7784 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7785 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7786 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7787
7788 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7789 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007790
7791 Example :
7792 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007793 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7794 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7795 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007796 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007797 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7798 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007799 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007801
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007802log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007803 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7805 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007806
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007807 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7808 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7809 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7810 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7811 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007812
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007813 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7814 "option httplog" directives.
7815
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007816log-format-sd <string>
7817 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7819 yes | yes | yes | no
7820
7821 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7822 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7823 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7824 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7825 which covers the log format string in depth.
7826
7827 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7828 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7829
7830 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7831 log format to "rfc5424".
7832
7833 Example :
7834 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7835
7836
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007837log-tag <string>
7838 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7839 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7840 yes | yes | yes | yes
7841
7842 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7843 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7844 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7845 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7846 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7847 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7848 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7849 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7850 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007851
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007852max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7853 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7855 yes | no | yes | yes
7856
7857 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7858 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7859 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7860 servers.
7861
7862 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7863 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7864 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7865 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7866 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007867 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007868 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7869 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7870 picking a different server.
7871
7872 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7873 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7874 even if they have to be queued.
7875
7876 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7877 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7878
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007879max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7880 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7881 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7882 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007884maxconn <conns>
7885 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7887 yes | yes | yes | no
7888 Arguments :
7889 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7890 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7891 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7892 closes.
7893
7894 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7895 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7896 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7897 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007898 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7899 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7900 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7901 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007902
7903 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7904 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7905 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7906
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007907 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7908 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007910 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7911
7912
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007913mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007914 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7916 yes | yes | yes | yes
7917 Arguments :
7918 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7919 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7920 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7921 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7922
7923 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7924 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7925 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7926 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7927 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7928
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007929 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7930 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7931 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007932
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007933 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007934 defaults http_instances
7935 mode http
7936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007937
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007938monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007939 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7941 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007942 Arguments :
7943 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7944 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007945 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007946 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7947 backend and its backup.
7948
7949 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7950 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7951 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7952 servers in a list of backends.
7953
7954 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7955 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7956 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7957 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7958 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7959 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7960 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007961 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7962 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007963
7964 Example:
7965 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007966 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007967 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7968 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7969 monitor-uri /site_alive
7970 monitor fail if site_dead
7971
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007972 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007973
7974
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007975monitor-uri <uri>
7976 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7978 yes | yes | yes | no
7979 Arguments :
7980 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7981 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7982
7983 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7984 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7985 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7986 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7987 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7988 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7989 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7990 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7991
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007992 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007993 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7994 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7995 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7996 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7997 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7998 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007999
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008000 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8001 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8002 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8003 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008005 Example :
8006 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
8007 frontend www
8008 mode http
8009 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8010
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008011 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008013
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008014option abortonclose
8015no option abortonclose
8016 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 yes | no | yes | yes
8019 Arguments : none
8020
8021 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8022 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8023 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8024 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008025 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008026 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8027 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8028 encountered while delivering the response.
8029
8030 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8031 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8032 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8033 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8034 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8035 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008036 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008037 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008038 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008039 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8040 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8041 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8042
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008043 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8044 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008045 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8046 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8047 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8048 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8049 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8050 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008051 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008052
8053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8055
8056 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8057
8058
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008059option accept-invalid-http-request
8060no option accept-invalid-http-request
8061 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | yes | yes | no
8064 Arguments : none
8065
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008066 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008067 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008068 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008069 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8070 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8071 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8072 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8073 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008074 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8075 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8076 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8077 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008078 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008079 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008080 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8081 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8082 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008083
8084 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8085 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8086 been confirmed.
8087
8088 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8089 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008090 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8091 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008092 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8093
8094 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8095 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8096
8097 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8098 stats socket.
8099
8100
8101option accept-invalid-http-response
8102no option accept-invalid-http-response
8103 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8105 yes | no | yes | yes
8106 Arguments : none
8107
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008108 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008109 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008110 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008111 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8112 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8113 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8114 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8115 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008116 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8117 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8118 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008119
8120 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8121 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8122 been confirmed.
8123
8124 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8125 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8126 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8127 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8128
8129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8131
8132 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8133 stats socket.
8134
8135
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008136option allbackups
8137no option allbackups
8138 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8140 yes | no | yes | yes
8141 Arguments : none
8142
8143 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8144 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8145 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8146 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8147 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8148 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8149 order between the backup servers anymore.
8150
8151 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8152 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8153
8154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8156
8157
8158option checkcache
8159no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008160 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8162 yes | no | yes | yes
8163 Arguments : none
8164
8165 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8166 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008167 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008168 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8169 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008170 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008171
8172 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008173 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008174 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8176 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008177 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008178 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008179 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8180 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008181 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008182 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8183 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008184 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008185 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8186 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8187 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8188 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8189 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8190 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8191 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8192 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8193 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8194
8195 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008196 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8197 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8198 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8199 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008200
8201 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8202 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008203 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008204 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008205
8206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8208
8209
8210option clitcpka
8211no option clitcpka
8212 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8214 yes | yes | yes | no
8215 Arguments : none
8216
8217 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8218 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008219 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008220 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8221
8222 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8223 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8224 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8225 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8226
8227 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8228 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8229 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8230 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8231 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8232
8233 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8234
8235 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8236 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8237 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8238
8239 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8240 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8241
8242 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8243
8244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008245option contstats
8246 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8248 yes | yes | yes | no
8249 Arguments : none
8250
8251 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8252 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8253 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8254 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008255 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8256 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8257 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8258 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8259 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008260
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008261option disable-h2-upgrade
8262no option disable-h2-upgrade
8263 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8264 connection.
8265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8266 yes | yes | yes | no
8267 Arguments : none
8268
8269 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8270 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8271 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8272 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008273 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8274 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8275 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8276 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8277 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8278 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008279
8280 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8281 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008282
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008283option dontlog-normal
8284no option dontlog-normal
8285 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8287 yes | yes | yes | no
8288 Arguments : none
8289
8290 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8291 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8292 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8293 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8294 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8295 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8296 logged.
8297
8298 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8299 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8300 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008302 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008303 logging.
8304
8305
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008306option dontlognull
8307no option dontlognull
8308 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8310 yes | yes | yes | no
8311 Arguments : none
8312
8313 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8314 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8315 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8316 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8317 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8318 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008319 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8320 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8321 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008322
8323 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008324 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008325 would not be logged.
8326
8327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8329
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008330 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008331 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008332
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008333
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008334option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008335 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8337 yes | yes | yes | yes
8338 Arguments :
8339 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8340 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008341 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008342 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008343
8344 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8345 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8346 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8347 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8348 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8349 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8350 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008351 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8352 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8353 possible that the client has already brought one.
8354
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008355 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008356 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008357 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008358 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008360 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008361
8362 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8363 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8364 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8365 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8366 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8367 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008368 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008369
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008370 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8371 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8372 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8373 are under the control of the end-user.
8374
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008375 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008376 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8377 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008378 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8379 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8380 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008382 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008383 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8384 frontend www
8385 mode http
8386 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8387
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008388 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8389 backend www
8390 mode http
8391 option forwardfor header X-Client
8392
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008393 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008394 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008395
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008396
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008397option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8398no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8399 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8401 yes | yes | yes | no
8402 Arguments : none
8403
8404 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8405 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8406 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8407 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8408 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8409 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8410 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8411
8412 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8413 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8414 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8415 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8416 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8417 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8418 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8419 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8420 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8421 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8422
8423 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8424
8425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8427
8428 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8429 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8430
8431
8432option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8433no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8434 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 yes | no | yes | yes
8437 Arguments : none
8438
8439 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8440 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8441 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8442 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8443 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8444 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8445 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8446
8447 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8448 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8449 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8450 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8451 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8452 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8453 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8454 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8455 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8456 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8457
8458 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8459
8460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8462
8463 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8464 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8465
8466
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008467option http-buffer-request
8468no option http-buffer-request
8469 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 yes | yes | yes | yes
8472 Arguments : none
8473
8474 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8475 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8476 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8477 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8478 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8479 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008480 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8481 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8482 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8483 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008484
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008485 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8486 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008487
8488
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008489option http-ignore-probes
8490no option http-ignore-probes
8491 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8493 yes | yes | yes | no
8494 Arguments : none
8495
8496 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8497 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8498 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8499 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8500 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8501 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8502 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8503 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8504 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008505 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8506 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008507 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8508
8509 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8510 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8511 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8512 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8513 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8514 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8515 are often the only way to detect them.
8516
8517 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8518 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8519
8520 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8521
8522
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008523option http-keep-alive
8524no option http-keep-alive
8525 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8527 yes | yes | yes | yes
8528 Arguments : none
8529
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008530 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8531 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008532 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8533 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008534 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8535 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8536 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008537
8538 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8539 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008540 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8541 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8542 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8543 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8544 situations where this option may be useful :
8545
8546 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008547 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008548
8549 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8550 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8551
8552 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8553 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8554 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8555 request.
8556
8557 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8558 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008559 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8560 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8561 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008562
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008563 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8564 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8565 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8566 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8567 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8568 not set.
8569
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008570 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8571 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8572 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008573
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008574 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008575 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008576 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008577
8578
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008579option http-no-delay
8580no option http-no-delay
8581 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8583 yes | yes | yes | yes
8584 Arguments : none
8585
8586 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8587 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8588 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8589 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8590 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8591 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8592 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8593 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8594 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8595 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8596 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8597 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8598 affected.
8599
8600 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8601 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8602 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8603 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8604 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8605 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8606 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8607 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8608 latency environments.
8609
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008610 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8611
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008612
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008613option http-pretend-keepalive
8614no option http-pretend-keepalive
8615 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008617 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008618 Arguments : none
8619
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008620 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008621 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8622 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8623 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8624 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8625 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8626 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8627 consider the response complete.
8628
8629 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8630 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8631 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8632 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008633 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008634 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8635
8636 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8637 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8638 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8639 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8640 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8641 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8642 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8643
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008644 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8645 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8646 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8647 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8648 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8649 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008650
8651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8653
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008654 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008655 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008656
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008657
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008658option http-server-close
8659no option http-server-close
8660 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8662 yes | yes | yes | yes
8663 Arguments : none
8664
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008665 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8666 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8667 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8668 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008669 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8670 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8671 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8672 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8673 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8674 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8675 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8676 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8677 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8678 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8679 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008680
8681 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8682 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8683 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8684 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008685 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8686 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008687
8688 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8689 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008690 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8691 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8692 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008693
8694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8696
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008697 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8698 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008699
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008700option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008701no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008702 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 yes | yes | yes | no
8705 Arguments : none
8706
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008707 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008708 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8709 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8710 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8711 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8712 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8713 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8714
8715 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8716 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008717 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8718 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8719 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008720
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008721 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8722 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8723 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8724 front of an existing proxy.
8725
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008726 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8727
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008728 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008730option httpchk
8731option httpchk <uri>
8732option httpchk <method> <uri>
8733option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008734 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8736 yes | no | yes | yes
8737 Arguments :
8738 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8739 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8740 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8741 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8742 ones.
8743
8744 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8745 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8746 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8747
8748 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8749 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8750 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008751 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008752
8753 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8754 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8755 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8756 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8757 the lack of any response.
8758
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008759 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8760 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8761 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8762 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8763
8764 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8765 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8766 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008767
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008768 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8769 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008770 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008771 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008772 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008773
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008774 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8775 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8776 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8777 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8778
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008779 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008780 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8781 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8782 backend https_relay
8783 mode tcp
8784 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8785 http-check send hdr Host www
8786 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008787
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008788 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8789 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8790 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791
8792
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008793option httpclose
8794no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008795 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8797 yes | yes | yes | yes
8798 Arguments : none
8799
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008800 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8801 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8802 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8803 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008804 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008805
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008806 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8807 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008808 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008809 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8810 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008811
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008812 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8813 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8814 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008815
8816 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8817 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008818 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8819 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8820 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008821
8822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8824
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008825 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008826
8827
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008828option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008829 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008831 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008832 Arguments :
8833 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8834 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8835 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008836 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008837 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008838
8839 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8840 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8841 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8842 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8843 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8844 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8845 ports.
8846
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008847 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8848 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008849
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008850 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008852 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008853
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008854
8855option http_proxy
8856no option http_proxy
8857 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8859 yes | yes | yes | yes
8860 Arguments : none
8861
8862 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8863 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8864 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8865 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8866 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8867
8868 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8869 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008870 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8871 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008872
8873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8875
8876 Example :
8877 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8878 backend direct_forward
8879 option httpclose
8880 option http_proxy
8881
8882 See also : "option httpclose"
8883
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008884
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008885option independent-streams
8886no option independent-streams
8887 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8889 yes | yes | yes | yes
8890 Arguments : none
8891
8892 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8893 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8894 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8895 receive data or not.
8896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008897 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008898 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8899 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8900 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8901 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8902 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8903 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8904 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8905 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8906 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8907 socket buffers.
8908
8909 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8910 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8911 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8912 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8913 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8914
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008915 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008916
8917
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008918option ldap-check
8919 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8921 yes | no | yes | yes
8922 Arguments : none
8923
8924 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8925 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8926 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8927 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8928
8929 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8930 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8931
8932 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8933 configure it.
8934
8935 Example :
8936 option ldap-check
8937
8938 See also : "option httpchk"
8939
8940
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008941option external-check
8942 Use external processes for server health checks
8943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8944 yes | no | yes | yes
8945
8946 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8947 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8948 command".
8949
8950 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8951
8952 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8953
8954
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008955option log-health-checks
8956no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008957 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8959 yes | no | yes | yes
8960 Arguments : none
8961
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008962 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8963 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8964 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008965
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008966 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8967 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8968 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8969 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8970 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8971
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008972 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008973 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008974
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008975 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8976 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8977 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008978
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008979
8980option log-separate-errors
8981no option log-separate-errors
8982 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8984 yes | yes | yes | no
8985 Arguments : none
8986
8987 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8988 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8989 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8990 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8991 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8992 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8993 provides very important information.
8994
8995 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8996 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8997 error logs.
8998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008999 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009000 logging.
9001
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009002
9003option logasap
9004no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009005 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | yes | yes | no
9008 Arguments : none
9009
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009010 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9011 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9012 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9013 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9014
9015 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9016 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9017 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9018 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9019 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009020 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009021 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9022 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9023 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9024 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009025 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009027 Examples :
9028 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9029 mode http
9030 option httplog
9031 option logasap
9032 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9033
9034 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9035 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9036 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9037 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009039 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009040 logging.
9041
9042
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009043option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009044 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009047 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009048 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9049 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009050 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9051 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009052
9053 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9054 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009055 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009056 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9057 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9058 in the MySQL table, like this :
9059
9060 USE mysql;
9061 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9062 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9063
9064 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009066 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9067 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9068 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9069 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9070 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9071 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9072 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9073
9074 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9075 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009076
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009077 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009078
9079 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9080 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9081 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9082 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009083 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9084 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009085
9086 See also: "option httpchk"
9087
9088
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009089option nolinger
9090no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009091 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9093 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009094 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009095
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009096 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009097 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9098 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9099 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9100 connections.
9101
9102 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9103 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009104 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9105 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9106 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9107 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9108 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9109 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9110 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9111 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9112 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9113 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9114 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9115 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9116 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009117
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009118 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9119 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9120 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9121 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9122 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009123
9124 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9125 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009126 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009127 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009128 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009129
9130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9132
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009133 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9134 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009135
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009136option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9137 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9139 yes | yes | yes | yes
9140 Arguments :
9141 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9142 matching <network>
9143 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9144 header name.
9145
9146 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9147 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9148 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9149 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9150 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9151 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9152 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9153 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9154 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9155 possible that the client has already brought one.
9156
9157 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9158 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9159 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9160 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9161 header and requires different one.
9162
9163 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9164 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9165 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009166 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9167 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9168 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9169 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9170 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009171
9172 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9173 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9174 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9175 both are defined.
9176
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009177 Examples :
9178 # Original Destination address
9179 frontend www
9180 mode http
9181 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9182
9183 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9184 backend www
9185 mode http
9186 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9187
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009188 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009189
9190
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009191option persist
9192no option persist
9193 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9195 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009196 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009197
9198 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9199 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9200 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9201 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9202 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9203 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9204 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9205 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9206 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9207 redirected to another valid server.
9208
9209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9211
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009212 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009213
9214
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009215option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9216 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 yes | no | yes | yes
9219 Arguments :
9220 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9221 PostgreSQL server.
9222
9223 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9224 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9225 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9226 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9227
9228 See also: "option httpchk"
9229
9230
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009231option prefer-last-server
9232no option prefer-last-server
9233 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9235 yes | no | yes | yes
9236 Arguments : none
9237
9238 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9239 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9240 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9241 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9242 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9243 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9244 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9245 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9246 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009247 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9248 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009249 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9250 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9251 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009252 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9253 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9254 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009255
9256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9258
9259 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9260
9261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009262option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009263option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009264no option redispatch
9265 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9267 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009268 Arguments :
9269 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9270 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9271 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009272 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009273 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009274 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009275 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9276 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9277 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009279
9280 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9281 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9282 be able to access the service anymore.
9283
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009284 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9285 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009286
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009287 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9288 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9289 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9290 following order:
9291
9292 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9293
9294 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9295 list, or
9296
9297 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9298
9299 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9300 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9301
9302 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9303 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9304 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9305 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9306
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009307 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009308 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9309 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009311 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9312 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9313
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009314 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009315
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009316
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009317option redis-check
9318 Use redis health checks for server testing
9319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9320 yes | no | yes | yes
9321 Arguments : none
9322
9323 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9324 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9325 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9326 find the "+PONG" response message.
9327
9328 Example :
9329 option redis-check
9330
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009331 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009332
9333
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009334option smtpchk
9335option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9336 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9338 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009339 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009340 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009341 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009342 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9343
9344 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9345 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9346 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9347
9348 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9349 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9350 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9351 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9352 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9353 dead server.
9354
9355 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9356 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009357 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009358 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9359
9360 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9361 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9362 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9363 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009364 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009365
9366 Example :
9367 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9368
9369 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009372option socket-stats
9373no option socket-stats
9374
9375 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9377 yes | yes | yes | no
9378
9379 Arguments : none
9380
9381
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009382option splice-auto
9383no option splice-auto
9384 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | yes | yes | yes
9387 Arguments : none
9388
9389 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9390 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009391 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009392 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009393 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009394 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9395 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9396 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9397 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9398
9399 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9400 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9401 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9402 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9403 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9404 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9405 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9406 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9407 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9408 keyword.
9409
9410 Example :
9411 option splice-auto
9412
9413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9415
9416 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9417 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9418
9419
9420option splice-request
9421no option splice-request
9422 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9424 yes | yes | yes | yes
9425 Arguments : none
9426
9427 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009428 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009429 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9430 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9431 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9432 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9433
9434 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9435
9436 Example :
9437 option splice-request
9438
9439 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9440 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9441
9442 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9443 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9444
9445
9446option splice-response
9447no option splice-response
9448 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 yes | yes | yes | yes
9451 Arguments : none
9452
9453 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009454 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009455 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9456 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9457 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9458 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9459
9460 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9461
9462 Example :
9463 option splice-response
9464
9465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9467
9468 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9469 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9470
9471
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009472option spop-check
9473 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9475 no | no | no | yes
9476 Arguments : none
9477
9478 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9479 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9480 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9481 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9482
9483 Example :
9484 option spop-check
9485
9486 See also : "option httpchk"
9487
9488
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009489option srvtcpka
9490no option srvtcpka
9491 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9493 yes | no | yes | yes
9494 Arguments : none
9495
9496 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9497 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009498 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009499 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9500
9501 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9502 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9503 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9504 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9505
9506 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9507 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9508 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9509 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9510 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9511
9512 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9513
9514 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9515 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9516 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9517
9518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9520
9521 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9522
9523
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009524option ssl-hello-chk
9525 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9527 yes | no | yes | yes
9528 Arguments : none
9529
9530 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9531 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9532 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9533 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9534 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9535 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9536 hello message.
9537
9538 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9539 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9540 messages, which is appreciable.
9541
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009542 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9543 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9544 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009545
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009546 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9547
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009548
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009549option tcp-check
9550 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9552 yes | no | yes | yes
9553
9554 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9555 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9556
9557 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9558 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9559 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9560
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009561 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009562 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9563 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9564 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9565 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9566 only.
9567
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009568 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009569 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9570 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9571 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9572 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9573
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009574 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009575 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9576 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009577 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009578 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9579 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9580 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9581 the respective protocols.
9582 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009583 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009585 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009586
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009587 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9588 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9589 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9590 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009591
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009592 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9593 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9594 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009595
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009596
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009597 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009598 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009599 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009600 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009602 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009603 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009604 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009605
9606 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9607 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009609 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009610 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009611 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009612 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009613 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009614 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9615 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009616 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009617 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9618 tcp-check expect string +OK
9619
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009620 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009621 (send many headers before analyzing)
9622 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009623 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9625 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9626 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9627 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009628 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009629
9630
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009631 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009632
9633
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009634option tcp-smart-accept
9635no option tcp-smart-accept
9636 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9638 yes | yes | yes | no
9639 Arguments : none
9640
9641 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9642 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9643 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9644 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9645 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9646 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9647
9648 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9649 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9650 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9651 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9652
9653 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9654 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9655 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009656 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009657
9658 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9659 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9660 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9661
9662 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9663 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9664 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9665
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009666 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9667
9668
9669option tcp-smart-connect
9670no option tcp-smart-connect
9671 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 yes | no | yes | yes
9674 Arguments : none
9675
9676 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9677 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9678 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9679 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9680 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9681
9682 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9683 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9684 complex.
9685
9686 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9687 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9688 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9689
9690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9692
9693 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9694
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009695
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009696option tcpka
9697 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9699 yes | yes | yes | yes
9700 Arguments : none
9701
9702 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9703 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009704 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009705 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9706
9707 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9708 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9709 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9710 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9711
9712 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9713 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9714 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9715 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9716 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9717
9718 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9719
9720 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9721 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9722 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9723 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9724 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9725 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9726 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9727 backends.
9728
9729 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9730
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009731
9732option tcplog
9733 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009735 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009736 Arguments : none
9737
9738 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9739 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9740 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9741 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9742 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9743 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9744 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9745 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9746
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009747 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009749 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009750
9751
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009752option transparent
9753no option transparent
9754 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009756 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009757 Arguments : none
9758
9759 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9760 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9761 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9762 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9763 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9764 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9765 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9766 appropriate server.
9767
9768 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9769 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9770
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009771 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009772 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009773
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009774
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009775external-check command <command>
9776 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9778 yes | no | yes | yes
9779
9780 Arguments :
9781 <command> is the external command to run
9782
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009783 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9784
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009785 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009786
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009787 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9788 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9789 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9790 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9791 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9792 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009793
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009794 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9795
9796 Environment variables :
9797 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9798 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9799
9800 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9801
9802 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9803
9804 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9805 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9806 for a UNIX socket).
9807
9808 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9809
9810 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9811
9812 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9813
9814 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9815
9816 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9817
9818 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9819 socket).
9820
9821 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9822 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9823
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009824 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9825
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009826 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9827 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9828 failed.
9829
9830 Example :
9831 external-check command /bin/true
9832
9833 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9834
9835
9836external-check path <path>
9837 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9839 yes | no | yes | yes
9840
9841 Arguments :
9842 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9843
9844 The default path is "".
9845
9846 Example :
9847 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9848
9849 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9850 "external-check command"
9851
9852
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009853persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009854persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009855 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9857 yes | no | yes | yes
9858 Arguments :
9859 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009860 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9861 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009862
9863 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9864 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009865 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009866 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9867 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9868 forwarded to this server.
9869
9870 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9871 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9872 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009873 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009874 a single "listen" section.
9875
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009876 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9877 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9878 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9879
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009880 Example :
9881 listen tse-farm
9882 bind :3389
9883 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9884 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9885 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9886 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9887 persist rdp-cookie
9888 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009889 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009890 balance rdp-cookie
9891 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9892 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9893
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009894 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9895 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009896
9897
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009898rate-limit sessions <rate>
9899 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9901 yes | yes | yes | no
9902 Arguments :
9903 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9904 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9905
9906 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9907 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9908 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9909 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9910 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9911 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9912
9913 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9914 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9915 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9916 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9917
9918 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9919 listen smtp
9920 mode tcp
9921 bind :25
9922 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009923 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009924
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009925 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9926 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9927 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009928
9929 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9930
9931
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009932redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9933redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9934redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009935 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9937 no | yes | yes | yes
9938
9939 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009940 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009941
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009942 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009943 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009944 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9945 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9946 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009947
9948 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9949 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9950 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9951 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9952 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009953 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9954 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9955 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9956 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009957
9958 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9959 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9960 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9961 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9962 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9963 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009964 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009965 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009966 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9967 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9968 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009969
9970 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009971 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9972 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9973 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009974 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009975 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9976 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9977 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9978 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009979
9980 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009981 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009982
9983 - "drop-query"
9984 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9985 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9986 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9987 with a location-type redirect.
9988
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009989 - "append-slash"
9990 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9991 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9992 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9993 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9994
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009995 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9996 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9997 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9998 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9999 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10000 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10001 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10002
10003 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10004 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10005 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10006 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10007 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10008 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10009 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010010
10011 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10012 acl clear dst_port 80
10013 acl secure dst_port 8080
10014 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010015 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010016 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010017 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10018
10019 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010020 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10021 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10022 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010023 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010024
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010025 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10026 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10027 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10028
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010029 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010030 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010031
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010032 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010033 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10034 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10035 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010037 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010038
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010039
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010040retries <value>
10041 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10043 yes | no | yes | yes
10044 Arguments :
10045 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10046 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10047 default value is 3.
10048
10049 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10050 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10051 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10052
10053 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010054 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10055 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010056
10057 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10058 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10059
10060 See also : "option redispatch"
10061
10062
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010063retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010064 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10065 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10066 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10068 yes | no | yes | yes
10069 Arguments :
10070 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10071 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10072 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10073 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10074
10075 none never retry
10076
10077 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10078 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10079
10080 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10081 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10082 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10083 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10084 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10085 processing the request.
10086
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010087 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10088 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10089 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10090 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10091 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10092 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10093 overflow attack for example).
10094
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010095 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10096 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10097 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10098 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10099 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10100 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10101 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10102 amplify denial of service attacks.
10103
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010104 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10105 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10106 considered to be safe to retry.
10107
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010108 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10109 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10110 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10111 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10112 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010113
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010114 all-retryable-errors
10115 retry request for any error that are considered
10116 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10117 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10118 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10119
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010120 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10121 not cumulative.
10122
10123 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10124 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10125 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10126 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10127
10128 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10129 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10130 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10131 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10132 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10133 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10134 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10135 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10136 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10137 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10138 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10139 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10140
10141 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10142 should not use this directive.
10143
10144 The default is "conn-failure".
10145
10146 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10147
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010148server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010149 Declare a server in a backend
10150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10151 no | no | yes | yes
10152 Arguments :
10153 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010154 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010155 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010156
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010157 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10158 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10159 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10160 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010161 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10162 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10163 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10164 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10165 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010166 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10167 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10168 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10169 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10170 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10171 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10172 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010173 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010174 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10175 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10176 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10177 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10178 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10179 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010180 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10181 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010182 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10183 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010185 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010186 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10187 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10188 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10189 adding this value to the client's port.
10190
10191 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10192 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010193 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010194
10195 Examples :
10196 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10197 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010198 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010199 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10200 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10201 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010202
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010203 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10204 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10205 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10206 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10207 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10208
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010209 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10210 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010211
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010212server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010213 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010214 this backend.
10215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10216 no | no | yes | yes
10217
10218 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10219 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10220 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10221 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10222 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010223
10224 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10225 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10226
10227 global
10228 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10229
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010230 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010231 load-server-state-from-file
10232
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010233 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010234 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010235
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010236server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10237 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10238 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10240 no | no | yes | yes
10241
10242 Arguments:
10243 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10244
10245 <num | range>
10246 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10247 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10248 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10249 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10250
10251 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10252
10253 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10254
10255 <params*>
10256 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10257 keyword.
10258
10259 Examples:
10260 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10261 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10262 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10263
10264 # or
10265 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10266
10267 # would be equivalent to:
10268 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10269 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10270 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10271
10272
10273
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010274source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010275source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010276source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010277 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10279 yes | no | yes | yes
10280 Arguments :
10281 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10282 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010284 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010285 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10286 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10287 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10288 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10289 supported prefixes are :
10290 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10291 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10292 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010293 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010294 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10295 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010296
10297 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10298 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010299 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10300 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10301 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010302
10303 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10304 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10305 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10306 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10307 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10308 <addr>.
10309
10310 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10311 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10312 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10313 port.
10314
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010315 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10316 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10317 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10318 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010319 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010320 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10321 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10322 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10323 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10324 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10325 HTTP header.
10326
10327 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10328 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010329 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010330 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10331 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10332 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10333 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10334 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10335 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10336 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10337
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010338 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10339 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10340 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10341 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10342 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10343 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10344
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010345 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10346 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10347 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10348 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10349
10350 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10351 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10352 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10353 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10354 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10355 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10356
10357 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10358 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10359 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10360 there are two methods :
10361
10362 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10363 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10364 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10365 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10366 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10367 of the client ranges may be used.
10368
10369 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10370 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10371 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10372 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10373 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10374 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10375 same session.
10376
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10378 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10379 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010380 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010381
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010382 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10383
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010384 Examples :
10385 backend private
10386 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10387 source 192.168.1.200
10388
10389 backend transparent_ssl1
10390 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10391 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10392
10393 backend transparent_ssl2
10394 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10395 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10396 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10397
10398 backend transparent_ssl3
10399 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10400 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10401 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10402
10403 backend transparent_smtp
10404 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10405 # with Tproxy version 4.
10406 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10407
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010408 backend transparent_http
10409 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10410 # proxy.
10411 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010413 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010414 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10415
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010416
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010417srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10418 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10419 the connection on the server side.
10420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10421 yes | no | yes | yes
10422 Arguments :
10423 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10424
10425 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10426 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010427 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10428 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010429
10430 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10431
10432
10433srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10434 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10435 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10436 server side.
10437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10438 yes | no | yes | yes
10439 Arguments :
10440 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10441 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10442 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10443 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10444
10445 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10446 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010447 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10448 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010449
10450 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10451
10452
10453srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10454 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10456 yes | no | yes | yes
10457 Arguments :
10458 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10459 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10460 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10461 document.
10462
10463 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10464 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010465 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10466 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010467
10468 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10469
10470
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010471stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10472 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010474 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010475
10476 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10477 matched.
10478
10479 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10480 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10481
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010482 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10483 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010484 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010485
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010486 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10487 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10488 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10489 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010490
10491 Example :
10492 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10493 backend stats_localhost
10494 stats enable
10495 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10496
10497 Example :
10498 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10499 backend stats_auth
10500 stats enable
10501 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10502 stats admin if TRUE
10503
10504 Example :
10505 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10506 userlist stats-auth
10507 group admin users admin
10508 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10509 group readonly users haproxy
10510 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10511
10512 backend stats_auth
10513 stats enable
10514 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10515 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10516 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10517 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10518
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010519 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10520 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10521 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010522
10523
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010524stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10525 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010527 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010528 Arguments :
10529 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10530
10531 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10532
10533 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10534 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10535 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10536 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10537 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10538 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10539
10540 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10541 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10542 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010543 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010544
10545 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10546 report using "stats scope".
10547
10548 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10549 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10550 unobvious parameters.
10551
10552 Example :
10553 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10554 backend public_www
10555 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10556 stats enable
10557 stats hide-version
10558 stats scope .
10559 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010560 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10562 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10563
10564 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10565 backend private_monitoring
10566 stats enable
10567 stats uri /admin?stats
10568 stats refresh 5s
10569
10570 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10571
10572
10573stats enable
10574 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010576 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010577 Arguments : none
10578
10579 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10580 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10581 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10582 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10583 - stats auth : no authentication
10584 - stats scope : no restriction
10585
10586 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10587 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10588 unobvious parameters.
10589
10590 Example :
10591 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10592 backend public_www
10593 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10594 stats enable
10595 stats hide-version
10596 stats scope .
10597 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010598 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010599 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10600 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10601
10602 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10603 backend private_monitoring
10604 stats enable
10605 stats uri /admin?stats
10606 stats refresh 5s
10607
10608 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10609
10610
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010611stats hide-version
10612 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010614 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010615 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010617 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10618 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10619 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10620 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10621 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10622 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010624 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10625 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10626 unobvious parameters.
10627
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010628 Example :
10629 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10630 backend public_www
10631 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010632 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010633 stats hide-version
10634 stats scope .
10635 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010636 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010637 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10638 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010639
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010640 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10641 backend private_monitoring
10642 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010643 stats uri /admin?stats
10644 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010646 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010647
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010648
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010649stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10650 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10651 Access control for statistics
10652
10653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10654 no | no | yes | yes
10655
10656 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10657 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10658 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10659 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10660 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10661 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10662
10663 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10664 instance.
10665
10666 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10667 about ACL usage.
10668
10669
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010670stats realm <realm>
10671 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010673 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010674 Arguments :
10675 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10676 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10677 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10678
10679 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10680 using a backslash ('\').
10681
10682 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10683 only related to authentication.
10684
10685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10687 unobvious parameters.
10688
10689 Example :
10690 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10691 backend public_www
10692 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10693 stats enable
10694 stats hide-version
10695 stats scope .
10696 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010697 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010698 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10699 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10700
10701 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10702 backend private_monitoring
10703 stats enable
10704 stats uri /admin?stats
10705 stats refresh 5s
10706
10707 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10708
10709
10710stats refresh <delay>
10711 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010713 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010714 Arguments :
10715 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10716 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10717 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10718 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10719 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10720 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10721
10722 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10723 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10724 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010725 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726
10727 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10728 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10729 unobvious parameters.
10730
10731 Example :
10732 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10733 backend public_www
10734 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10735 stats enable
10736 stats hide-version
10737 stats scope .
10738 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010739 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10741 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10742
10743 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10744 backend private_monitoring
10745 stats enable
10746 stats uri /admin?stats
10747 stats refresh 5s
10748
10749 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10750
10751
10752stats scope { <name> | "." }
10753 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010756 Arguments :
10757 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10758 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10759 section in which the statement appears.
10760
10761 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10762 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10763 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10764 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10765 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10766 exists.
10767
10768 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10769 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10770 unobvious parameters.
10771
10772 Example :
10773 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10774 backend public_www
10775 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10776 stats enable
10777 stats hide-version
10778 stats scope .
10779 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010780 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010781 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10782 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10783
10784 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10785 backend private_monitoring
10786 stats enable
10787 stats uri /admin?stats
10788 stats refresh 5s
10789
10790 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10791
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010792
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010793stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010794 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010796 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010797
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010798 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010799 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10800
10801 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10802 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10803
10804 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10805 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807
10808 Example :
10809 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10810 backend private_monitoring
10811 stats enable
10812 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10813 stats uri /admin?stats
10814 stats refresh 5s
10815
10816 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10817 global section.
10818
10819
10820stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010821 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10823 yes | yes | yes | yes
10824 Arguments : none
10825
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010826 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010827 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10828 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10829 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10830 - IP (socket, server)
10831 - cookie (backend, server)
10832
10833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010835 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010836
10837 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10838
10839
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010840stats show-modules
10841 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10843 yes | yes | yes | yes
10844 Arguments : none
10845
10846 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10847 values as a tooltip.
10848
10849 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10850 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10851 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10852
10853 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10854
10855
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010856stats show-node [ <name> ]
10857 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010859 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010860 Arguments:
10861 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10862 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10863
10864 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10865 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010866 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010867
10868 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10869 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10870 unobvious parameters.
10871
10872 Example:
10873 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10874 backend private_monitoring
10875 stats enable
10876 stats show-node Europe-1
10877 stats uri /admin?stats
10878 stats refresh 5s
10879
10880 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10881 section.
10882
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010883
10884stats uri <prefix>
10885 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010887 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010888 Arguments :
10889 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10890 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10891 query string.
10892
10893 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10894 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10895 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10896 possible to reach it in the application.
10897
10898 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010899 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010900 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10901 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10902 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10903 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10904
10905 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10906 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10907 an address or a port to statistics only.
10908
10909 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10910 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10911 unobvious parameters.
10912
10913 Example :
10914 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10915 backend public_www
10916 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10917 stats enable
10918 stats hide-version
10919 stats scope .
10920 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010921 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010922 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10923 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10924
10925 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10926 backend private_monitoring
10927 stats enable
10928 stats uri /admin?stats
10929 stats refresh 5s
10930
10931 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10932
10933
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10935 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010937 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010938
10939 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010940 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010941 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010942 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010943 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10944
10945 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10946 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10947 the "stick-table" statement.
10948
10949 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10950 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10951 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10952 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10953 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10954
10955 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10956 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10957 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10958 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10959 transformation rules.
10960
10961 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10962 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10963 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10964 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10965 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10966 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10967 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10968
10969 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10970 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10971 ACL based conditions.
10972
10973 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10974 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10975 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10976 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10977
10978 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10979 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10980 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10981 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10982
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010983 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10984 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010985 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010986
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010987 Example :
10988 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10989 # last 30 minutes
10990 backend pop
10991 mode tcp
10992 balance roundrobin
10993 stick store-request src
10994 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10995 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10996 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10997
10998 backend smtp
10999 mode tcp
11000 balance roundrobin
11001 stick match src table pop
11002 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11003 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11004
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011005 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011006 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011007
11008
11009stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11010 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11012 no | no | yes | yes
11013
11014 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11015 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11016 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11017 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11018
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011019 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11020 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011021 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011022
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011023 Examples :
11024 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011025 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011026
11027 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11028 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11029 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11030
11031
11032 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11033 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11034 backend http
11035 mode http
11036 balance roundrobin
11037 stick on src table https
11038 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11039 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11040 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11041
11042 backend https
11043 mode tcp
11044 balance roundrobin
11045 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11046 stick on src
11047 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11048 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11049
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011050 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011051
11052
11053stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11054 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11056 no | no | yes | yes
11057
11058 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011059 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011060 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011061 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011062 server is selected.
11063
11064 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11065 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11066 the "stick-table" statement.
11067
11068 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11069 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11070 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11071 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11072 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11073 address.
11074
11075 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11076 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11077 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11078 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11079 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11080 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11081 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11082 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11083 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11084 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11085
11086 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11087 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11088 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11089 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11090 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11091 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11092 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11093
11094 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11095 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11096 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11097 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11098
11099 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11100 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11101 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11102 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11103 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11104 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011105 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11106 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11107 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11108 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11109 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11110 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011111
11112 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11113 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11114 the request.
11115
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011116 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11117 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011118 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011119
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011120 Example :
11121 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11122 # last 30 minutes
11123 backend pop
11124 mode tcp
11125 balance roundrobin
11126 stick store-request src
11127 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11128 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11129 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11130
11131 backend smtp
11132 mode tcp
11133 balance roundrobin
11134 stick match src table pop
11135 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11136 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11137
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011138 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011139 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011140
11141
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011142stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011143 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011144 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011145 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011147 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011148
11149 Arguments :
11150 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11151 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11152 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11153 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11154
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011155 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11156 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11157 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11158 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11159
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011160 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11161 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11162 instance.
11163
11164 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11165 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11166 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11167 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11168 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11169 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011170 to 32 characters.
11171
11172 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11173 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11174 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011175 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011176 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11177 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011178
11179 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011180 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11181 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011182 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11183 increase.
11184
11185 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011186 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11187 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11188 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011189
11190 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11191 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11192 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11193 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011194 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011195 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11196 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11197 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11198 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11199 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11200 parameter (see below).
11201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011202 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11203 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11204 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11205 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11206 soft restart.
11207
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011208 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11209 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011210
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011211 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11212 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11213 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11214 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011215 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011216 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011217 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11218 if not expiration delay is specified.
11219
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011220 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11221 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11222 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11223 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11224 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11225 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11226 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11227 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11228 token.
11229
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011230 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11231 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11232 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11233 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011234 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11235 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11236 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11237 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11238 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11239 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11240 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11241 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11242 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11243 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11244 types and their arguments.
11245
11246 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11247 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11248 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11249 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11250
11251 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11252 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11253 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011254 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011255
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011256 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11257 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11258 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011259 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011260 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011261 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011262
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011263 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11264 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11265 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11266 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11267
11268 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11269 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11270 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11271 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11272 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11273 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11274
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011275 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11276 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11277 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11278 they were received.
11279
11280 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11281 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11282 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11283 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11284 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11285
11286 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11287 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11288 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11289 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11290 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11291
11292 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11293 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11294 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11295
11296 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11297 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11298 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11299 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11300 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11301
11302 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11303 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11304 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11305 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11306 the client side.
11307
11308 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11309 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11310 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11311 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11312 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11313 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11314 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11315
11316 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11317 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11318 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11319 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11320 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11321 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011322 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011323
11324 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11325 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11326 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11327 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11328 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11329 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11330
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011331 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11332 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11333 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11334 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11335 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11336
11337 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11338 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11339 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11340 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11341 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11342 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11343
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011344 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011345 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011346 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11347 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11348
11349 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11350 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11351 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11352 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11353 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11354 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11355 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11356 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11357 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11358 recommended for better fairness.
11359
11360 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011361 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011362 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11363 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11364
11365 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11366 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11367 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11368 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11369 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11370 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11371 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11372 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11373 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11374 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011375
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011376 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11377 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011378 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11379 reference it.
11380
11381 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11382 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011383 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11384 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11385 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011386
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011387 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11388 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11389 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11390 something that can be ignored.
11391
11392 Example:
11393 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11394 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11395 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11396 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11397
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011398 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011399 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011400
11401
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011402stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011403 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11405 no | no | yes | yes
11406
11407 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011408 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011409 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011410 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011411 server is selected.
11412
11413 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11414 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11415 the "stick-table" statement.
11416
11417 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11418 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11419 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11420 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11421
11422 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11423 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11424 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11425 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11426 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11427 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011428 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011429 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11430 rules.
11431
11432 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11433 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11434 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11435 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11436 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11437 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11438 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11439
11440 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11441 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11442 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11443 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11444
11445 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11446 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11447 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11448 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11449 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11450 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011451 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11452 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11453 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11454 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11455 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11456 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11457 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11458 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11459 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011460
11461 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11462
11463 Example :
11464 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11465 backend https
11466 mode tcp
11467 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011468 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011469 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011470
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011471 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11472 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11473
11474 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11475 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11476 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11477
11478 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11479 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011480
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011481 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11482 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11483 # at offset 44.
11484
11485 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11486 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11487
11488 # Learn on response if server hello.
11489 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011490
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011491 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11492 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11493
11494 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11495 extraction.
11496
11497
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011498tcp-check comment <string>
11499 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11500 it fails.
11501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11502 yes | no | yes | yes
11503
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011504 Arguments :
11505 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11506 rule fails.
11507
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011508 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11509 user-friendly error reporting.
11510
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011511 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11512 "tcp-check expect".
11513
11514
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011515tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11516 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011517 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011518 Opens a new connection
11519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011520 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011522 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011523 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11524
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011525 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011526 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011527
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011528 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011529 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11530 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011531 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011532
11533 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011534
11535 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11536
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011537 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11538
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011539 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11540
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011541 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11542
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011543 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11544 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11545 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11546 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11547
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011548 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11549 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11550 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11551 haproxy -vv.
11552
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011553 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011555 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11556 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11557 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11558
11559 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11560 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11561 of the sequence.
11562
11563 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11564 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11565 do.
11566
11567 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11568 unset-var or comment rules.
11569
11570 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011571 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11572 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11573 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11574 option tcp-check
11575 tcp-check connect
11576 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11577 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11578 tcp-check send \r\n
11579 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11580 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11581 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11582 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11583 tcp-check send \r\n
11584 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11585 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11586
11587 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11588 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011589 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011590 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11591 tcp-check connect port 143
11592 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11593 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11594
11595 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11596
11597
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011598tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011599 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011600 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011601 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011602 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011604 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011605
11606 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011607 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11608
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011609 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11610 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11611 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11612 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11613 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11614 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11615 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11616 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11617 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11618 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11619
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011620 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011621 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11622 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011623 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11624 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11625 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11626
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011627 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11628 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11629 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011630 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11631 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011632 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11633 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011634 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11635 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011636 By default "L7OK" is used.
11637
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011638 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11639 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011640 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11641 supported :
11642 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11643 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011644 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11645 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11646 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11647 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11648 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011649
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011650 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011651 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011652 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11653 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11654 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11655 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011656 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11657
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011658 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11659 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11660 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11661 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11662
11663 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11664 informational message reported in logs if an error
11665 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11666 log-format string.
11667
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011668 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11669 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11670 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11671 followed by some converters.
11672
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011673 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11674 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11675 with the usual backslash ('\').
11676 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011677 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011678 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11679 used upper or lower case.
11680
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011681 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11682
11683 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11685 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11686 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11687 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11688 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11689 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11690 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11691
11692 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11694 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11695 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11696 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11697 expression.
11698
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011699 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11700 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11701 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11702 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11703 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11704 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11705
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011706 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11707 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11708 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11709 this exact hexadecimal string.
11710 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11711
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011712 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11713 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11714 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11715 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11716 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11717 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11718 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11719 size.
11720
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011721 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11722 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11723 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11724 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11725 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11726 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11727 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11728 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11729 in a binary string before matching the response's
11730 buffer.
11731
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011732 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011733 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011734 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11735 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11736 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11737 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11738 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11739 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11740 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11741 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11742 the null character.
11743
11744 Examples :
11745 # perform a POP check
11746 option tcp-check
11747 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11748
11749 # perform an IMAP check
11750 option tcp-check
11751 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11752
11753 # look for the redis master server
11754 option tcp-check
11755 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011756 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011757 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11758 tcp-check expect string role:master
11759 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11760 tcp-check expect string +OK
11761
11762
11763 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011764 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011765
11766
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011767tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11768tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11769 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11770 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011772 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011773
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011774 Arguments :
11775 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11776
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011777 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11778 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011779
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011780 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11781 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011782
11783 Examples :
11784 # look for the redis master server
11785 option tcp-check
11786 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11787 tcp-check expect string role:master
11788
11789 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011790 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011791
11792
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011793tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11794tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11795 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11796 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011798 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011799
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011800 Arguments :
11801 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011802
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011803 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11804 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011805
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011806 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11807 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11808 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011809
11810 Examples :
11811 # redis check in binary
11812 option tcp-check
11813 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11814 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11815
11816
11817 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011818 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011819
11820
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011821tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011822 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011824 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011825
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011826 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011827 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11828 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11829 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11830 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11831 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11833 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11834 and '-'.
11835
11836 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11837
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011838 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011839 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11840
11841
11842tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011843 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011845 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011846
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011847 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011848 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11849 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11850 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11851 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11852 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11853 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11854 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11855 and '-'.
11856
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011857 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011858 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11859
11860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011861tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11862 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11864 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011866 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11867 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011868
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011869 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011870
11871 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11872 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011873 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11874 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11875 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11876 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11877 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11878 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011880 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11881 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11882 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11883 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011884
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011885 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011886 - accept :
11887 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11888 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11889 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011890
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011891 - reject :
11892 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11893 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11894 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11895 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11896 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11897 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11898 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11899 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11900 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11901 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11902 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011903 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011904
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011905 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11906 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11907 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11908 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11909 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11910 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11911 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11912 hosts.
11913
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011914 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11915 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11916 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11917 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11918 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11919 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11920 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11921 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11922
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011923 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11924 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11925 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11926 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11927 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11928 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11929 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11930 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11931 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011932 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11933 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011934
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011935 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011936 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011937 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11938 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11939 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011940 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011941 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011942 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11943 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11944 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11945 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11946 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11947 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11948 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011950 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011951 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011952 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011953 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011954 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11955 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11956 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011958 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11959 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11960 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11961 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011963 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11964 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11965 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11966 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11967 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011968 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11969 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11970 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11971 layer7 information is extracted.
11972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011973 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11974 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11975 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11976 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11977 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011978
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011979 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11980 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11981 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11982 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11983
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011984 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11985 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11986 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11987 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11988
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011989 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11990 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11991 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11992 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11993 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011994
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011995 - set-src <expr> :
11996 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11997 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11998 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011999 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012001 Arguments:
12002 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12003 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012004
12005 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012006 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12007
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012008 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12009 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012010
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012011 - set-src-port <expr> :
12012 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12013 expression.
12014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012015 Arguments:
12016 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12017 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012018
12019 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012020 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12021
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012022 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12023 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12024 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012025
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012026 - set-dst <expr> :
12027 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12028 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12029 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12030 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12031 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12032
12033 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12034 followed by some converters.
12035
12036 Example:
12037
12038 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12039 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12040
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012041 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12042 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12043
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012044 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12045 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12046 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12047 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12048
12049
12050 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12051 followed by some converters.
12052
12053 Example:
12054
12055 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12056
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012057 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12058 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12059 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12060
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012061 - "silent-drop" :
12062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012063 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012064 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12065 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12066 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12067 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12068 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012069 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12070 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012071 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12072 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012074 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12075 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12076 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12077 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012079 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12080 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12081 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012083 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12084 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12085 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012087 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012088 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012089 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12092 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12093 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012095 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012096 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12097 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012098
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012099 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12100
12101 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12102
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012103 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12104
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012105 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012106
12107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012108tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12109 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012111 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012112 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012113 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12114 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012116 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012117
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012118 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012119 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12120 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012121 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12122 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012124 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12125 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12126 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12127 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012128 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12129 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12130 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12131 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12132 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12133 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012134 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012135 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012137 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12138 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12139 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12140 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012141
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012142 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012143 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012144 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012145 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12146 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012147 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012148 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012149 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012150 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012151 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012152 - set-dst <expr>
12153 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012154 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012155 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012156 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012157 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012158 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012159 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012161 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12162 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012163 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12164 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012165
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012166 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12167 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12168 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12169 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12170 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12171 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012173 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012174 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12175 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012176
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012177 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12178 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12179 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12180 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12181 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12182 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012184 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012185 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12186 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12187 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12188 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12189 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12190 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12191 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12192 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12193 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12194 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012195
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012196 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012197 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12198 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12199 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012200
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012201 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12202 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12203
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012204 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012205 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12206 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012207
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012208 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12209 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012210 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012211 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12212 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012213 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012214 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012215 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012216 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12217 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012218 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012219 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12220 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012221
12222 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12223 followed by some converters.
12224
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012225 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12226 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12227 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12228 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12229 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12230 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12231 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012232 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012233 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12234 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12235
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012236 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12237
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012238 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12239 <var-name>.
12240
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012241 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12242 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12243 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12244 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12245 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12246
12247 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12248 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12249 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12250 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12251 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12252 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12253 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12254 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12255 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12256 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12257 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12258
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012259 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12260 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12261 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12262 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12263 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12264
12265 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12266
12267 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12268
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012269 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12270 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12271 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12272 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12273 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12274 evaluated.
12275
12276 Example:
12277 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12278
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012279 Example:
12280
12281 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012282 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012283
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012284 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012285 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012286 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12288 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012289 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012290 tcp-request content reject
12291
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012292 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12293 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12294 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12295 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12296 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12297 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12298 ...
12299 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012301 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012302 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12303 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12304 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012305 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012306
12307 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12308 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12309 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012310 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012311 tcp-request content reject
12312
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012313 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012314 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012315 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012316 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012317 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12318 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012319
12320 Example:
12321 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12322 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012323 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012325 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012326 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012327
12328 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012329 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012330 # protecting all our sites
12331 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012332 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12333 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012334 ...
12335 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12336
12337 backend http_dynamic
12338 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012339 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012340 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012341 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012342 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012343 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012344 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012346 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012347
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012348 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12349 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350
12351
12352tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12353 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012355 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012356 Arguments :
12357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12359 as explained at the top of this document.
12360
12361 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12362 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12363 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12364 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12365 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12366
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012367 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12368 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12369 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12370 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12371
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012372 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12373 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012374 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012375 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012376 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12377 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12378 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12379 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012380
12381 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12382 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12383 it pass through unaffected.
12384
12385 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12386 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12387 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012388 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012389 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12390 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012391 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12392 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12393 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012394
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012395 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012396 "timeout client".
12397
12398
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012399tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12400 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12402 no | no | yes | yes
12403 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012404 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12405 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012406
12407 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12408
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012409 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012410 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12411 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012412 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12413 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012414
12415 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12416
12417 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12418 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12419 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12420 inserted.
12421
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012422 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012423 - accept :
12424 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12425 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12426 the rules evaluation.
12427
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012428 - close :
12429 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12430 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12431 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12432 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12433 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12434 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012435 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012436 protocols.
12437
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012438 - reject :
12439 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12440 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012441 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012442
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012443 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12444 Sets a variable.
12445
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012446 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12447 Unsets a variable.
12448
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012449 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12450 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12451 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12452 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12453
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012454 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12455 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12456 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12457 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12458
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012459 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12460 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12461 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12462 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12463 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012464
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012465 - "silent-drop" :
12466 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012467 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012468 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12469 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12470 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12471 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12472 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012473 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12474 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012475 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12476 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012477 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012478 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12479 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12480 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12481 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12482
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012483 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12484 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12485
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012486 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12487 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12488 for changing the default action to a reject.
12489
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012490 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12491 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12492 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12493 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012494 period.
12495
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012496 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12497 declared inline.
12498
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012499 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12500 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012504 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012506 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012507 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12508 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012509 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012510 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12511 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012512
12513 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12514 followed by some converters.
12515
12516 Example:
12517
12518 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12519
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012520 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12521 <var-name>.
12522
12523 Example:
12524
12525 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12526
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012527 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12528 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12529 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12530 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12531 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12532
12533 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12534
12535 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12536
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012537 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12538
12539 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12540
12541
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012542tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12543 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12545 no | yes | yes | no
12546 Arguments :
12547 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12548 below.
12549
12550 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012552 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012553 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12554 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12555 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12556 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12557 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12558 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12559 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012560 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012561 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12562 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12563 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12564 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12565 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12566 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12567 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12568 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12569 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12570 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12571 instead.
12572
12573 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12574 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12575 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12576 rules which may be inserted.
12577
12578 Several types of actions are supported :
12579 - accept : the request is accepted
12580 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12581 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12582 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012583 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012584 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012585 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012586 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012587 - silent-drop
12588
12589 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12590 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12591 sections for a complete description.
12592
12593 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12594 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12595 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12596
12597 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12598 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12599 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12600 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12601 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12602
12603 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12604 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12605
12606 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12607 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12608 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12609
12610 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12611 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12612 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12613
12614 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12615 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12616 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12617
12618 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12619 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12620 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12621
12622 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12623
12624 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12625
12626
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012627tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12628 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12630 no | no | yes | yes
12631 Arguments :
12632 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12633 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12634 as explained at the top of this document.
12635
12636 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12637
12638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012639timeout check <timeout>
12640 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12641 established.
12642
12643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12644 yes | no | yes | yes
12645 Arguments:
12646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12648 as explained at the top of this document.
12649
12650 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12651 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012653 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012654 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12655 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12656 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012657
12658 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12659 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12660
12661 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12662 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012663 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012664
12665 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12666 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12667 forget about it.
12668
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012669 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12670 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012671
12672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012673timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012674 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12676 yes | yes | yes | no
12677 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012678 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012679 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12680 as explained at the top of this document.
12681
12682 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12683 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12684 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012685 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12686 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12687 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12688 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012689 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12690 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12691 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012692 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012693 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012694 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12695 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012696 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12697 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012698
12699 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12700 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12701 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12702 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012703 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012704 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12705
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012706 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012707
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012708 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012709
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012710
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012711timeout client-fin <timeout>
12712 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12714 yes | yes | yes | no
12715 Arguments :
12716 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12717 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12718 as explained at the top of this document.
12719
12720 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12721 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12722 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12723 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12724 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12725 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12726 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012727 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12728 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12729 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012730
12731 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12732 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12733 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12734
12735 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12736
12737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012738timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012739 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12741 yes | no | yes | yes
12742 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012743 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012744 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12745 as explained at the top of this document.
12746
12747 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012748 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012749 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012750 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012751 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12752 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012753
12754 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12755 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12756 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12757 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012758 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012759 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12760
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012761 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012764timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12765 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12767 yes | yes | yes | yes
12768 Arguments :
12769 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12771 as explained at the top of this document.
12772
12773 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12774 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12775 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12776 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12777 once the request has started to present itself.
12778
12779 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12780 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12781 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12782 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12783 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12784
12785 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12786 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12787 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12788 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12789
12790 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12791 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012792 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012793 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12794 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012795 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012796
12797 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12798 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12799 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12800 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12801
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012802 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12803 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012804 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12805
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012806 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12807
12808
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012809timeout http-request <timeout>
12810 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012812 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12816 as explained at the top of this document.
12817
12818 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12819 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12820 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12821 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12822 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12823 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12824 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012825 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12826 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12827 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12828 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012829 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012830 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12831 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012832
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012833 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12834 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12835 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12836 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12837 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012838 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012839
12840 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12841 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012842 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012843 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12844 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12845
12846 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012847 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12848 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12849 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012850
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012851 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012852 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012853
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012854
12855timeout queue <timeout>
12856 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12858 yes | no | yes | yes
12859 Arguments :
12860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12862 as explained at the top of this document.
12863
12864 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12865 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12866 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12867 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12868 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12869
12870 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12871 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12872 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12873 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12874
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012875 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012876
12877
12878timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012879 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12881 yes | no | yes | yes
12882 Arguments :
12883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12885 as explained at the top of this document.
12886
12887 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12888 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12889 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12890 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12891 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12892 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12893 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12894
12895 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12896 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12897 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12898 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12899 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012900 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012901 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012902 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12903 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012904 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12905 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012906
12907 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12908 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12909 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12910 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012911 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012912 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12913
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012914 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012915
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012916
12917timeout server-fin <timeout>
12918 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12920 yes | no | yes | yes
12921 Arguments :
12922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12924 as explained at the top of this document.
12925
12926 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12927 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12928 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12929 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12930 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12931 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12932 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12933 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12934 situations, it should not be needed.
12935
12936 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12937 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12938 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12939
12940 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12941
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012942
12943timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012944 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12946 yes | yes | yes | yes
12947 Arguments :
12948 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12949 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12950 as explained at the top of this document.
12951
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012952 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12953 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12954 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012955
12956 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12957 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12958 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12959 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012960 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012961
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012962 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012963
12964
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012965timeout tunnel <timeout>
12966 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12968 yes | no | yes | yes
12969 Arguments :
12970 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12971 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12972 as explained at the top of this document.
12973
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012974 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012975 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12976 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12977 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012978 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12979 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012980 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12981 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12982 specified.
12983
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012984 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12985 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12986 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12987 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12988 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12989 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12990 state.
12991
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012992 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12993 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12994 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12995 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012996 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012997
12998 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12999 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13000 forget about it.
13001
13002 Example :
13003 defaults http
13004 option http-server-close
13005 timeout connect 5s
13006 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013007 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013008 timeout server 30s
13009 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13010
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013011 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013012
13013
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013014transparent (deprecated)
13015 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013017 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013018 Arguments : none
13019
13020 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13021 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13022 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13023 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13024 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13025 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13026 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13027 appropriate server.
13028
13029 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13030
13031 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13032 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13033
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013034 See also: "option transparent"
13035
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013036unique-id-format <string>
13037 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13039 yes | yes | yes | no
13040 Arguments :
13041 <string> is a log-format string.
13042
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013043 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13044 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13045 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13046 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013047
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013048 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13049 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13050 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13051 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13052 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13053 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13054 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13055 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013057 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13058 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013059
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013060 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013061
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013062 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013063
13064 will generate:
13065
13066 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13067
13068 See also: "unique-id-header"
13069
13070unique-id-header <name>
13071 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13073 yes | yes | yes | no
13074 Arguments :
13075 <name> is the name of the header.
13076
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013077 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13078 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013079
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013080 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013081
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013082 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013083 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13084
13085 will generate:
13086
13087 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13088
13089 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013090
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013091use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013092 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13094 no | yes | yes | no
13095 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013096 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13097 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013098
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013099 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13100 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101
13102 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13103 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13104 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013105 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013106 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013107 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13108 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013109
13110 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13111 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13112 assign the backend.
13113
13114 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13115 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13116 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13117 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13118 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13119 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13120
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013121 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013122 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013123 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13124 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13125 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13126
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013127 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13128 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13129 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13130 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13131 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13132 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13133 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13134 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13135 cannot be forced from the request.
13136
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013137 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013138 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13139 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13140
13141 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13142 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013143
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013144use-fcgi-app <name>
13145 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13147 no | no | yes | yes
13148 Arguments :
13149 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13150
13151 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013152
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013153use-server <server> if <condition>
13154use-server <server> unless <condition>
13155 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13157 no | no | yes | yes
13158 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013159 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13160 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013161
13162 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13163
13164 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13165 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13166 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13167
13168 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13169 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13170 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13171 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13172 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13173 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13174 matches will assign the server.
13175
13176 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13177 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13178 with the next rules until one matches.
13179
13180 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13181 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13182 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13183 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13184
13185 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13186 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13187 stripped.
13188
13189 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13190 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013191 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13192 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13193 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013194
13195 Example :
13196 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13197 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13198 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13199 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013200 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013201 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013202 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013203 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13204 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13205
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013206 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13207 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13208 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13209 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013210 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013211 and we fall back to load balancing.
13212
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013213 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013214
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132165. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013217--------------------------
13218
13219The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13220depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13221settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13222written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13223described in this section.
13224
13225
132265.1. Bind options
13227-----------------
13228
13229The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13230as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13231no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13232parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13233while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13234provided immediately after the setting name.
13235
13236The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13237
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013238accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13239 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13240 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13241 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13242 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13243 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13244 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13245 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13246 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13247 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013248 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13249 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13250 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013251
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013252accept-proxy
13253 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013254 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13255 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013256 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13257 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13258 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13259 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013260 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013261 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13262 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013263 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13264 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013265
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013266allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013267 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013268 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013269 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013270 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13271 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013272
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013273alpn <protocols>
13274 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13275 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13276 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013277 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013278 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013279 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13280 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13281 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13282 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13283 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13284 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13285 preference, like below :
13286
13287 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013288
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013289backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013290 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013291 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13292
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013293curves <curves>
13294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13295 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13296 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13297 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13298 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13299 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13300
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013301ecdhe <named curve>
13302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013303 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13304 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013305
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013306ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13308 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13309 client's certificate.
13310
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013311ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13313 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13314 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13315 error is ignored.
13316
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013317ca-sign-file <cafile>
13318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13319 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13320 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13321 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13322 'generate-certificates' for details.
13323
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013324ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13326 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13327 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13328 'generate-certificates' for details.
13329
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013330ca-verify-file <cafile>
13331 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13332 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13333 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13334 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13335 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13336
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013337ciphers <ciphers>
13338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13339 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013340 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013341 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013342 information and recommendations see e.g.
13343 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13344 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13345 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13346
13347ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13349 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13350 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13351 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013352 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13353 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013354
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013355crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13357 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13358 to verify client's certificate.
13359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013360crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13362 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13363 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13364 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13365 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013366 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13367 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013368
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013369 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13370 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13371
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013372 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13373 are loaded.
13374
13375 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013376 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13377 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13378 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13379 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13380 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13381 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13382 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013383 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013384
13385 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13386 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13387 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13388 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013389 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13390 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013391
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013392 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013393
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013394 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013395 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013396 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13397 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013398 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13399 clients).
13400
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013401 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13402 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13403 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13404 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13405 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13406 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13407 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13408 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13409 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13410 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13411 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13412 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13413 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13414
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013415 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13416 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13417 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13418 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13419 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13420
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013421 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13422 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13423 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13424 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013425
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013426 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13427 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13428 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013429
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013430crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013431 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013432 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013433 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013434 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013435
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013436crt-list <file>
13437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013438 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13439 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013440
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013441 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13442
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013443 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13444 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13445 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13446 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13447 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013448
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013449 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013450 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13451 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13452 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13453 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13454 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013455 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13456 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13457 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013458
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013459 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13460 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13461 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013462
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013463 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13464
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013465 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13466 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13467 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13468 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13469 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13470 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13471 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13472 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013473
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013474 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013475 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013476 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013477 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013478 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013479 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013480
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013481defer-accept
13482 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13483 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13484 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013485 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013486 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13487 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13488 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13489 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13490 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13491 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13492 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13493
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013494expose-fd listeners
13495 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13496 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013497 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13498 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013499 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013500
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013501force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013502 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013503 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013504 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013505 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013506
13507force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013508 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013509 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013510 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013511
13512force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013513 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013514 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013515 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013516
13517force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013518 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013519 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013520 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013521
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013522force-tlsv13
13523 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13524 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013525 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013526
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013527generate-certificates
13528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13529 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13530 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13531 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13532 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13533 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13534 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13535 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13536 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13537 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13538 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13539
13540 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13541 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013543 certificate is used many times.
13544
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013545gid <gid>
13546 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13547 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13548 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13549 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13550 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13551
13552group <group>
13553 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13554 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13555 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13556 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13557 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13558
13559id <id>
13560 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13561 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13562 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13563 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13564
13565interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013566 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13567 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13568 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13569 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13570 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13571 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013572 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13573 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13574 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13575 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13576 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13577 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013578
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013579level <level>
13580 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13581 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13582 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013583 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013584 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13585 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13586 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013587 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013588 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013589 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013590 all counters).
13591
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013592severity-output <format>
13593 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13594 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13595 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13596 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13597 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13598 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13599 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13600 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13601 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13602 rfc5424 convention.
13603
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013604maxconn <maxconn>
13605 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13606 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13607 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13608 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13609 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13610 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13611 eat all memory.
13612
13613mode <mode>
13614 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13615 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13616 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13617 UNIX sockets.
13618
13619mss <maxseg>
13620 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13621 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13622 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13623 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13624 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13625 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13626 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13627 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13628 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13629 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13630 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13631
13632name <name>
13633 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13634 page.
13635
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013636namespace <name>
13637 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13638 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13639 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13640 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13641
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013642nice <nice>
13643 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13644 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13645 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13646 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13647 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13648 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13649 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13650 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13651 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13652 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13653 one for an RDP socket.
13654
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013655no-ca-names
13656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13657 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013658 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013659
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013660no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013662 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013663 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013664 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013665 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13666 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013667
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013668no-tls-tickets
13669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13670 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13671 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013672 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13673 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013674 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13675 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13676 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013677
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013678no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013679 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013680 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013681 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013682 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013683 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13684 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013685
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013686no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013688 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013689 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013690 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013691 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13692 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013693
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013694no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013695 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013696 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013697 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013698 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013699 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13700 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013701
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013702no-tlsv13
13703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13704 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13705 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13706 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013707 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13708 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013709
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013710npn <protocols>
13711 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13712 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13713 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013714 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013715 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013716 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13717 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13718 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13719 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13720 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013721
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013722prefer-client-ciphers
13723 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13724 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13725 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013726 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13727 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13728 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013729
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013730process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013731 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013732 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013733 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013734 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13735 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13736 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13737 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013738 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013739 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13740 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13741 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13742 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13743 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013744
13745 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13746
13747 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13748 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13749 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13750 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13751 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13752 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13753 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13754 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013755
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013756proto <name>
13757 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13758 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13759 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013760 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13761 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13762
13763 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13764 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13765 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13766 also reported (flag=HTX).
13767
13768 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13769 a bind line :
13770
13771 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13772 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13773 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13774
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013775 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013776 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013777 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013778 h2" on the bind line.
13779
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013780ssl
13781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013782 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013783 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13784 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013785 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13786 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013787
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013788ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13789 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013790 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13791 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13792 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013793 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13794
13795ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013796 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13797 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13798 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13799 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013800
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013801strict-sni
13802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13803 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13804 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13805 See the "crt" option for more information.
13806
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013807tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013808 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013809 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13810 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013811 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013812 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13813 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13814 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13815 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13816 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13817 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13818 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13819
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013820tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013821 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013822 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13823 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13824 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13825 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13826 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13827 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13828 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013829 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13830 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13831 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013832
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013833tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13834 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013835 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13836 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13837 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13838 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13839 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13840 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13841 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13842 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13843 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13844 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013845 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13846 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13847
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013848transparent
13849 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13850 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13851 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13852 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13853 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13854 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13855 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13856 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13857 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13858 so check for support with your vendor.
13859
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013860v4v6
13861 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13862 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13863 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13864 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013865 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013866
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013867v6only
13868 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13869 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13870 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013871 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13872 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013873
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013874uid <uid>
13875 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13876 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13877 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13878 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13879 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13880
13881user <user>
13882 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13883 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13884 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13885 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13886 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13887
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013888verify [none|optional|required]
13889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13890 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13891 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13892 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13893 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013894 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13895 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13896 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13897 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013898
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200138995.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013900------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013902The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13903which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13904arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13905settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13906after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13907Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13908address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013910 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013911 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013912
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013913Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13914keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013916The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013917
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013918addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013919 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013920 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13921 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13922 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13923 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13924 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013925
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013926agent-check
13927 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013928 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013929 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13930 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13931 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013932
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013933 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013934 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013935 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13936 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13937 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013939 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13940 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13941 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13942 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13943 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013944
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013945 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013946 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013947
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013948 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13949 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13950 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013951
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013952 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13953 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13954 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013955
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013956 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013957 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13958 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13959 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13960 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013961 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013962 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013963
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013964 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13965 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013966
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013967 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13968 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13969 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13970 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13971 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13972 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13973 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13974 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13975 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013976
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013977 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13978 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013979 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13980 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13981 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013982 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013983
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013984 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013985 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013986
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013987agent-send <string>
13988 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13989 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13990 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13991 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13992 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13993
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013994agent-inter <delay>
13995 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13996 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13997
13998 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13999 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14000 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14001 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14002 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14003 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14004 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14005 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14006 of backends use the same servers.
14007
14008 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14009
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014010agent-addr <addr>
14011 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14012
14013 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
14014 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
14015 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14016 hostname, it will be resolved.
14017
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014018agent-port <port>
14019 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14020
14021 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14022
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014023allow-0rtt
14024 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014025 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14026 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014027
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014028alpn <protocols>
14029 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14030 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14031 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014032 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014033 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14034 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14035 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14036 now obsolete NPN extension.
14037 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14038 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14039
14040 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014042backup
14043 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14044 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14045 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14046 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014047 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14048 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014049
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014050ca-file <cafile>
14051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14052 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14053 server's certificate.
14054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014055check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014056 This option enables health checks on a server:
14057 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14058 considered available.
14059 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14060 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14061 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14062 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14063 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14064 set.
14065 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14066 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14067 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14068 exchanges succeed.
14069
14070 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14071 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14072 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14073 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14074 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014075 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014076 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14077
14078 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14079 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14080
14081 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14082 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14083
14084 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14085 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14086 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14087 available.
14088
14089 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14090 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14091 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14092
14093 Example:
14094 # simple tcp check
14095 backend foo
14096 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14097 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14098 backend foo
14099 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14100 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14101 backend foo
14102 option tcp-check
14103 tcp-check connect
14104 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014105
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014106check-send-proxy
14107 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14108 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14109 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14110 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14111 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14112 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14113 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14114
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014115check-alpn <protocols>
14116 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14117 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14118 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14119
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014120check-proto <name>
14121 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14122 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14123 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014124 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14125 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14126
14127 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14128 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14129 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14130 also reported (flag=HTX).
14131
14132 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14133 directive on a server line:
14134
14135 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14136 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14137 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14138 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14139
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014140 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014141 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14142 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14143
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014144check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014145 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014146 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14147 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014148
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014149check-ssl
14150 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14151 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14152 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14153 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014154 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014155 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14156 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014157 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014158 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14159 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014160
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014161check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014162 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014163 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14164 for normal traffic.
14165
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014166ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14168 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14169 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014170 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14171 information and recommendations see e.g.
14172 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14173 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14174 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014175
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014176ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14178 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14179 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14180 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014181 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14182 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14183 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014185cookie <value>
14186 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14187 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14188 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14189 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14190 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14191 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14192 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14193
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014194crl-file <crlfile>
14195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14196 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14197 to verify server's certificate.
14198
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014199crt <cert>
14200 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14201 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14202 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14203 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14204 certificate request.
14205
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014206disabled
14207 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14208 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14209 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14210 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14211 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014212 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014213
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014214enabled
14215 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14216 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14217 default value.
14218 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14219 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014221error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014222 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14223 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14224 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014226 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014228fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014229 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14230 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14231 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14232
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014233force-sslv3
14234 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14235 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014236 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014237 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014238
14239force-tlsv10
14240 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014241 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014242 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014243
14244force-tlsv11
14245 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014246 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014247 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014248
14249force-tlsv12
14250 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014251 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014252 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014253
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014254force-tlsv13
14255 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14256 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014257 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014259id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014260 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14261 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14262 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014263
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014264init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14265 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14266 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014267 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014268 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14269 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14270 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14271 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14272 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14273 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14274 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14275 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14276 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014277 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014278 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14279 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14280 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14281 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14282 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14283 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014284 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014285
14286 Example:
14287 defaults
14288 # never fail on address resolution
14289 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014291inter <delay>
14292fastinter <delay>
14293downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014294 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14295 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14296 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14297 between checks depending on the server state :
14298
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014299 Server state | Interval used
14300 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14301 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14302 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14303 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14304 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14305 or yet unchecked. |
14306 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14307 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14308 | "inter" otherwise.
14309 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014311 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14312 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14313 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14314 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014315 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14316 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14317 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14318 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14319 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014320
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014321log-proto <logproto>
14322 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14323 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14324 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14325 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014327maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014328 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14329 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014330 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14331 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014332 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14333 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14334 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14335 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14336
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014337 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14338 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14339 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14340 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14341 than 50 concurrent requests.
14342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014343maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014344 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14345 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14346 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14347 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014348 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14349 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14350 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14351 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14352 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14353 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14354 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014355
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014356max-reuse <count>
14357 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14358 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14359 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14360 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14361 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14362 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14363 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14364 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014366minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014367 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14368 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14369 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14370 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14371 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14372 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014373 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014374 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014375
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014376namespace <name>
14377 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14378 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14379 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14380 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14381
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014382no-agent-check
14383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14385 default value.
14386 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14387 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14388
14389no-backup
14390 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14391 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14392 default value.
14393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14394 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14395
14396no-check
14397 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14398 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14399 default value.
14400 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14401 "default-server" "check" setting.
14402
14403no-check-ssl
14404 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14405 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14406 default value.
14407 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14408 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14409
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014410no-send-proxy
14411 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14412 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14413 default value.
14414 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14415 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14416
14417no-send-proxy-v2
14418 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14419 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14420 default value.
14421 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14422 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14423
14424no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14425 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14426 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14427 default value.
14428 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14429 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14430
14431no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14432 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14433 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14434 default value.
14435 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14436 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14437
14438no-ssl
14439 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14440 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14441 default value.
14442 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14443 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14444
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014445 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14446 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14447 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14448
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014449no-ssl-reuse
14450 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14451 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14452 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14453 and for paranoid users.
14454
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014455no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014456 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14457 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014458 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014459
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014460 Supported in default-server: No
14461
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014462no-tls-tickets
14463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14464 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14465 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014466 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14467 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014468 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14469 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14470 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014471 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014472
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014473no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014474 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014475 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14476 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014477 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14478 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014479 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014480
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014481 Supported in default-server: No
14482
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014483no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014484 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014485 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14486 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014487 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14488 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014489 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014490
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014491 Supported in default-server: No
14492
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014493no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014494 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014495 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14496 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014497 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14498 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014499 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014500
14501 Supported in default-server: No
14502
14503no-tlsv13
14504 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14505 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14506 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14507 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14508 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014509 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014510
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014511 Supported in default-server: No
14512
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014513no-verifyhost
14514 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14515 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14516 default value.
14517 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14518 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014519
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014520no-tfo
14521 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14522 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14523 default value.
14524 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14525 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14526
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014527non-stick
14528 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14529 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14530 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14531
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014532npn <protocols>
14533 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14534 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14535 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014536 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014537 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14538 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14539 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014541observe <mode>
14542 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14543 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14544 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14545 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14546 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14547 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014548 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014549
14550 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014552on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014553 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14554 Currently, four modes are available:
14555 - fastinter: force fastinter
14556 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14557 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14558 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14559 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14560
14561 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14562
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014563on-marked-down <action>
14564 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14565 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014566 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14567 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14568 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14569 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14570 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14571 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14572 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14573 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014574
14575 Actions are disabled by default
14576
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014577on-marked-up <action>
14578 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14579 Currently one action is available:
14580 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14581 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14582 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14583 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014584 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14585 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014586 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14587 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14588
14589 Actions are disabled by default
14590
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014591pool-low-conn <max>
14592 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14593 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14594 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14595 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14596 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14597 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14598 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14599 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14600 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14601 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014602 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14603 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14604 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14605 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014606
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014607pool-max-conn <max>
14608 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14609 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14610 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14611 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14612 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14613 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14614
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014615pool-purge-delay <delay>
14616 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014617 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014618 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014620port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014621 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014622 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14623 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14624 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14625 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14626 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014627
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014628proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014629 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14630 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14631 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014632 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14633 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14634
14635 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14636 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14637 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14638 also reported (flag=HTX).
14639
14640 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14641 a server line :
14642
14643 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14644 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14645 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14646 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14647
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014648 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014649 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014651redir <prefix>
14652 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14653 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14654 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14655 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14656 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14657 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14658 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14659 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014660 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014661 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014662 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14663 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14664 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14665 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14666
14667 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014669rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014670 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14671 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14672 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14673
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014674resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14675 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14676 server.
14677
14678 Available options:
14679
14680 * allow-dup-ip
14681 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14682 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14683 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14684 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14685 For such case, simply enable this option.
14686 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14687
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014688 * ignore-weight
14689 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14690 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14691 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14692
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014693 * prevent-dup-ip
14694 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14695 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14696 same fqdn.
14697 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14698
14699 Example:
14700 backend b_myapp
14701 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14702 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14703 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14704
14705 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14706 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14707 it
14708 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14709 different address
14710
14711 Default value: not set
14712
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014713resolve-prefer <family>
14714 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14715 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14716 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14717 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14718
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014719 Default value: ipv6
14720
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014721 Example:
14722
14723 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014724
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014725resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014726 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014727 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014728 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014729 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14730 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014731 configured network, another address is selected.
14732
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014733 Example:
14734
14735 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014736
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014737resolvers <id>
14738 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14739 hostname.
14740
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014741 Example:
14742
14743 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014744
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014745 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014746
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014747send-proxy
14748 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14749 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14750 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14751 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014752 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14753 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14754 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14755 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14756 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14757 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14758 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14759 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14760 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14761 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014762 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14763 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014764
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014765send-proxy-v2
14766 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14767 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14768 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14769 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014770 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14771 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14772 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14773 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014774
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014775proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014776 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14777 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14778
14779 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14780 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14781 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14782 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14783 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14784 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14785 connection is supported).
14786 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14787 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14788 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14789 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14790 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14791 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14792 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014793
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014794send-proxy-v2-ssl
14795 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14796 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14797 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14798 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14799 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14800 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14801 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014802 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14803 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014804
14805send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14806 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14807 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14808 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14809 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14810 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14811 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14812 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14813 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14815 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014817slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014818 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14819 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14820 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14821 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14822 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14823 parameters :
14824
14825 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14826 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14827
14828 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14829 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14830 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14831 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14832
14833 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14834 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14835 seen as failed.
14836
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014837sni <expression>
14838 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14839 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14840 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14841 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014842 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14843 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014844 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014845 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14846 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014847
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014848source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014849source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014850source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014851 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14852 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14853 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14854 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14855
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014856 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14857 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14858 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14859 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14860 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14861 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14862 server.
14863
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014864 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14865 specifying the source address without port(s).
14866
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014867ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014868 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14869 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14870 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14871 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14872 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14873 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014874 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14875 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014876
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014877ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14878 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14879 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14880 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14881
14882ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14883 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14884 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14885 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14886
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014887ssl-reuse
14888 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14889 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14890 default value.
14891 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14892 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14893
14894stick
14895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14897 default value.
14898 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14899 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014900
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014901socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014902 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014903 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14904 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14905
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014906tcp-ut <delay>
14907 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14908 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14909 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014910 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014911 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14912 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14913 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14914 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14915 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14916 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14917 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14918 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14919 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14920
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014921tfo
14922 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14923 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14924 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14925 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14926 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014927 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014929track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014930 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14931 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14932 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14933 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014934 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14935
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014936tls-tickets
14937 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14938 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14939 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014940 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14941 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14942 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014943 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014944 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014945
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014946verify [none|required]
14947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014948 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014949 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14950 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014952 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14953 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14954 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14955 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14956 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14957 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14958 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14959 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014960
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014961verifyhost <hostname>
14962 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014963 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14964 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14965 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14966 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14967 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14968 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14969 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14970 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014972weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014973 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14974 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14975 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014976 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14977 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14978 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14979 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14980 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14981 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014982
14983
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149845.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14985-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014986
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014987HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14988using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014989configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014990This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14991can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14992workload.
14993This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14994resolution at run time.
14995Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14996carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14997
14998
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149995.3.1. Global overview
15000----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015001
15002As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15003different steps of the process life:
15004
15005 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15006 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15007 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15008
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015009 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15010 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015011
15012A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15013 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15014 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15015 resolution to know this new IP.
15016
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015017When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015018HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015019SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15020from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
15021will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
15022will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015023
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015024A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015025 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015026 first valid response.
15027
15028 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15029 servers return an error.
15030
15031
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150325.3.2. The resolvers section
15033----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015034
15035This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015036HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15037contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015038
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015039When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15040uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15041is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15042answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15043
15044When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015045used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015046
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015047 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15048 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15049 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015050
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015051 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15052 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015053
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015054 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15055 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15056 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015057
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015058For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15059following scenarios are possible:
15060
15061 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15062 ignored
15063
15064 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15065 applied
15066
15067 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15068 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15069
15070 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15071 retries the query with a new type
15072
15073 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15074 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015075
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015076As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15077a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015078<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015079
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015080
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015081resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015082 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015083
15084A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15085
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015086accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015087 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015088 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015089 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15090 by RFC 6891)
15091
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015092 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15093 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15094 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15095 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15096 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15097 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015098
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015099nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15100 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15101 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15102 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15103 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15104 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15105 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15106 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15107 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15108 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015109 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15110
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015111parse-resolv-conf
15112 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15113 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15114 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15115
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015116hold <status> <period>
15117 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15118 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015119 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015120 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015121 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15122 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15123 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15124
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015125 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015126
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015127resolve_retries <nb>
15128 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15129 giving up.
15130 Default value: 3
15131
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015132 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15133 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15134 type.
15135
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015136timeout <event> <time>
15137 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15138 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15139 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015140 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15141 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015142 Default value: 1s
15143 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015144 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015145 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015146 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15147 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015149 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015150
15151 resolvers mydns
15152 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15153 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015154 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015155 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015156 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015157 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015158 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015159 hold other 30s
15160 hold refused 30s
15161 hold nx 30s
15162 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015163 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015164 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015165
15166
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151676. Cache
15168---------
15169
15170HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15171(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15172RAM.
15173
15174The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15175this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15176
15177If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15178independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15179when we try to allocate a new one.
15180
15181The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15182
15183It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15184"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15185for more details.
15186
15187When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15188replaced by "<CACHE>".
15189
15190
151916.1. Limitation
15192----------------
15193
15194The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15195
15196- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015197- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15198 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15199 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015200- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15201- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015202- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15203 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15204 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015205- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15206 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015207- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15208 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15209 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015210
15211- If the request is not a GET
15212- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15213- If the request contains an Authorization header
15214
15215
152166.2. Setup
15217-----------
15218
15219To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15220the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15221
15222
152236.2.1. Cache section
15224---------------------
15225
15226cache <name>
15227 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15228 size of cache is mandatory.
15229
15230total-max-size <megabytes>
15231 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15232 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15233
15234max-object-size <bytes>
15235 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15236 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15237 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15238
15239max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015240 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015241 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15242 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15243 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15244 default.
15245
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015246process-vary <on/off>
15247 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015248 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15249 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15250 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015251 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015252
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015253max-secondary-entries <number>
15254 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15255 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15256 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15257
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015258
152596.2.2. Proxy section
15260---------------------
15261
15262http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15263 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15264 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15265 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15266 after this one.
15267
15268http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15269 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15270 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15271 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15272 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15273
15274
15275Example:
15276
15277 backend bck1
15278 mode http
15279
15280 http-request cache-use foobar
15281 http-response cache-store foobar
15282 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15283
15284 cache foobar
15285 total-max-size 4
15286 max-age 240
15287
15288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152897. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15290----------------------------------
15291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015292HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015293client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15294The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15295these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15296but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15297data called patterns.
15298
15299
153007.1. ACL basics
15301---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015302
15303The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15304content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15305from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15306simple :
15307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015308 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015309 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15311 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15314adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015315
15316In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015319
15320This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15321Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15322and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015323an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15324conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15325as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15326are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015327
15328ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15329'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15330which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15331
15332There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15333performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15336specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15337this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015338methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15339ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340
15341Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15342 - boolean
15343 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15344 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15345 - string
15346 - data block
15347
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015348Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15349converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15350would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15351The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15352which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15353
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015354Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15355keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15356fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15357which are summarized in the table below :
15358
15359 +---------------------+-----------------+
15360 | Sample or converter | Default |
15361 | output type | matching method |
15362 +---------------------+-----------------+
15363 | boolean | bool |
15364 +---------------------+-----------------+
15365 | integer | int |
15366 +---------------------+-----------------+
15367 | ip | ip |
15368 +---------------------+-----------------+
15369 | string | str |
15370 +---------------------+-----------------+
15371 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15372 +---------------------+-----------------+
15373
15374Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15375matching method, see below.
15376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15378 - boolean
15379 - integer or integer range
15380 - IP address / network
15381 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15382 - regular expression
15383 - hex block
15384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015385The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15386
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015387 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15388 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015390 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015391 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015392 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015393 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15396read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15397if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15398lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15399will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15400beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15401a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15402lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15403exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15404
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015405The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15406parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15407ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15408a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15409check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15410
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015411The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15412socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15413file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015415Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15416loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15417
15418 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15419
15420In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15421the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15422case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15423as well.
15424
15425The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15426sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15427do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15428methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15429is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015430obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15432default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15433that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15434string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15435
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015436The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15437By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15438string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15439resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15440server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015441waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015442flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15443function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15446sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15447be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015448
15449 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15450 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15452 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15453 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15454 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015455
15456 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15457 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015459
15460 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015462
15463 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015465
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015466 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015467 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15468
15469 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15470 binary or string samples.
15471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15473 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15476 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15477 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15480 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15483 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15486 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15489 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015490 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15493 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15494 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015495
15496For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15497request, it is possible to do :
15498
15499 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15500
15501In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15502buffer, one would use the following acl :
15503
15504 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15505
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015506On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15507possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15508
15509 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15512criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15513method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15514to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15515criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15516the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015519the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15520For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15523 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15524 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15525 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015526
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015527
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015528The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15529types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15530combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15531brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15532default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534 +-------------------------------------------------+
15535 | Input sample type |
15536 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015537 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15539 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015541 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015543 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015545 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015547 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015549 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015551 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015553 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015555 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015557 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015559 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015561 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15563 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15564 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015565
15566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155677.1.1. Matching booleans
15568------------------------
15569
15570In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15571Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15572When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15573that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15574
15575Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15576return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15577"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155807.1.2. Matching integers
15581------------------------
15582
15583Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15584enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15585to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15586
15587Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15588matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15589lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015590
15591For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15592unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15593representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15594
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015595As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15596two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15597instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15598ranges and operators.
15599
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015600For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015601operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15602Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15603of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015605Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015606
15607 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15608 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15609 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15610 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15611 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015613For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015614
15615 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15616
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015617This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15618
15619 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156227.1.3. Matching strings
15623-----------------------
15624
15625String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15626different forms :
15627
15628 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015629 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630
15631 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015632 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633
15634 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15635 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15636
15637 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15638 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15639
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015640 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15642 matches.
15643
15644 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15645 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15646 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015647
15648String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15649exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15650characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15651string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15652to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015653before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015654
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015655Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15656(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15657Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15658
15659Example:
15660 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15661 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15662
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156647.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15665---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015666
15667Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15668they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15669possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15670passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15671the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015672the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15673match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015674
15675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156767.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15677-------------------------------------
15678
15679It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15680not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15681a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15682to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15683digits may be used upper or lower case.
15684
15685Example :
15686 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15687 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15688
15689
156907.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15691---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015692
15693IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15694netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15695within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015696host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015697difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15698at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15699does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15700parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015701
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015702The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15703abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15704
15705 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15706 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15707 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15708 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15709 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15710 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15711 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15712 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15713
15714Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15715192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15716
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015717IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15718Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15719trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15720IPv6 patterns.
15721
15722HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15723following situations :
15724 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15725 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15726 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15727 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15728 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15729 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15730 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15731 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15732 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15733 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735
157367.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15737----------------------------------
15738
15739Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15740combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15741
15742 - AND (implicit)
15743 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15744 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015748 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15751indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15754"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15755requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15756is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15757
15758 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015759 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15760 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15761 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762
15763To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15764and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15765
15766 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15767 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15768 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15769 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015771 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15773 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15774 use_backend www if host_www
15775
15776It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15777expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15778be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15779the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15780
15781 The following rule :
15782
15783 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015784 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785
15786 Can also be written that way :
15787
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015788 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789
15790It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15791to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15792simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15793sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15794good use is the following :
15795
15796 With named ACLs :
15797
15798 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15799 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15800 monitor fail if site_dead
15801
15802 With anonymous ACLs :
15803
15804 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15805
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015806See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15807keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808
15809
158107.3. Fetching samples
15811---------------------
15812
15813Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15814against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15815sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15816ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15817of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15818available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15819
15820This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15821Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15822compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15823deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15824
15825The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15826matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15827method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15828indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15829
15830As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15831when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15832mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15833the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15834ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15835
15836Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15837multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15838when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015839incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15840are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15842all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15843
15844Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15845 - name
15846 - name(arg1)
15847 - name(arg1,arg2)
15848
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015849
158507.3.1. Converters
15851-----------------
15852
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015853Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15854of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15855is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15856was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015857has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015858unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15859
15860These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15861sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15862the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015863support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015864
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015865A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15866support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15867supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15868(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15869bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015872
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001587351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15874 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15875 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15876 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15877 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15878 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15879
15880 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015881 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15882 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015883 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15884 frontend http-in
15885 bind *:8081
15886 default_backend servers
15887 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15888 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15889
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015890add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015891 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015892 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015893 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15894 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015895 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015896 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15897 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15898 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15899 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015900 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015901 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015902
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015903aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15904 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15905 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15906 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15907 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15908 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15909 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15910
15911 Example:
15912 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15913 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15914
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015915and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015916 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015917 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015918 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15919 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015920 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015927
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015928b64dec
15929 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15930 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015931 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15932 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015933
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015934base64
15935 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015936 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015937 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15938 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015939
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015940bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015941 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015942 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015943 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015944 presence of a flag).
15945
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015946bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15947 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15948 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015949 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015950
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015951concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15952 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15953 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15954 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15955 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15956 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15957 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15958 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15959 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15960 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15961 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015962 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015963 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015964 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15965 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015966
15967 Example:
15968 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15969 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15970 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015971 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015972 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15973
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015974cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015975 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15976 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015977
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015978crc32([<avalanche>])
15979 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15980 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15981 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15982 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15983 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15984 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15985 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15986 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15987 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15988 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015989 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15990
15991crc32c([<avalanche>])
15992 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15993 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15994 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15995 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15996 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15997 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15998 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15999 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016000
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016001cut_crlf
16002 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16003 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16004 updated.
16005
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016006da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016007 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16008 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16009 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16010 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016011 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016012 configuration language.
16013
16014 Example:
16015 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016016 bind *:8881
16017 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016018 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016019
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016020debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16021 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16022 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16023 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16024 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16025 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16026 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16027 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16028 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16029 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16030 printable sample types.
16031
16032 Example:
16033 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016034
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016035digest(<algorithm>)
16036 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16037 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16038
16039 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16040 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16041
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016042div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016043 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16044 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016045 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016046 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16047 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016048 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016049 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16050 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16051 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16052 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016053 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016054 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016055
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016056djb2([<avalanche>])
16057 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16058 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16059 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16060 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16061 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16062 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16063 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016064 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16065 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016066
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016067even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016068 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016069 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16070
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016071field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16072 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16073 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16074 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16075 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16076 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16077 fields.
16078
16079 Example :
16080 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16081 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16082 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16083 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16084 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016085
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016086fix_is_valid
16087 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16088 Information eXchange):
16089
16090 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16091 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016092 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016093 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016094 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016095 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16096 checksum
16097
16098 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16099 the server can be parsed.
16100
16101 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16102 message, false if not.
16103
16104 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16105
16106 Example:
16107 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16108 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16109
16110fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16111 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16112 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16113 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16114 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016115 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016116 added.
16117
16118 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16119 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16120 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16121 fix_is_valid converter.
16122
16123 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16124
16125 Example:
16126 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16127 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16128 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16129 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16130 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016132hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016133 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016134 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016135 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016136 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016137
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016138hex2i
16139 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016140 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016141
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016142htonl
16143 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16144 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16145 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16146 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16147
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016148hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016149 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16150 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16151 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16152 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16153
16154 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16155 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16156
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016157http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016158 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16159 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016160 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16161 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16162 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16163 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16164 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16165 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16166 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16167 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016169iif(<true>,<false>)
16170 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16171 string otherwise.
16172
16173 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016174 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016175
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016176in_table(<table>)
16177 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16178 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16179 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016180 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016181 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16182
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016183ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016184 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016185 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016186 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16187 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16188 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16189 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16190 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016191
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016192json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016193 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016194 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016195 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016196 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16197 of errors:
16198 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16199 bytes, ...)
16200 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16201 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16202
16203 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16204 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16205 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16206 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16207 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16208 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016209 - "ascii" : never fails;
16210 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16211 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016212 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016213 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016214 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16215 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16216
16217 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016218 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016219
16220 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016221 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016222 capture request header user-agent len 150
16223 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016224
16225 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16226 GET / HTTP/1.0
16227 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16228
16229 Output log:
16230 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16231
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016232json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16233 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16234 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16235 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16236 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16237
16238 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16239 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16240
16241 Example:
16242 # get a integer value from the request body
16243 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16244 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16245
16246 # get a key with '.' in the name
16247 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16248 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16249
16250 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16251 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16252
16253 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16254 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16255
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016256language(<value>[,<default>])
16257 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16258 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16259 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16260 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16261 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16262 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16263 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16264 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16265 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016266 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016267 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16268 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016269
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016270 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016271
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016272 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16273 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016274
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016275 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16276 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16277 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16278 use_backend spanish if es
16279 use_backend french if fr
16280 use_backend english if en
16281 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016282
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016283length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016284 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16285 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16286 type. The result is of type integer.
16287
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016288lower
16289 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16290 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16291 type. The result is of type string.
16292
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016293ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16294 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16295 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16296 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16297 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16298 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16299 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16300
16301 Example :
16302
16303 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016304 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016305 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16306
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016307ltrim(<chars>)
16308 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16309 representation of the input sample.
16310
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016311map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16312map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16313map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16314 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16315 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16316 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16317 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16318 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16319 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16320 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16321 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016322
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016323 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16324 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16325 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016326
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016327 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016328 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016330 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16331 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16332 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16333 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016334 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16335 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016336 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16337 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16338 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16339 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16340 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16341 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16342 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16343 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016344 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16345 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16346 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016347 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16348 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16349 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16350 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16351 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016352
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016353 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16354 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16355 the corresponding match text.
16356
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016357 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16358 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16359 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16360 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16361 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016362
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016363 Example :
16364
16365 # this is a comment and is ignored
16366 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16367 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16368 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16369 | | | `---------- value
16370 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16371 | `---------------------------- key
16372 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16373
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016374mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016375 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16376 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016377 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016378 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016379 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016380 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16381 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16382 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16383 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016384 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016385 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016386
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016387mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016388 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16389 <packettype>.
16390 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16391 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16392 from.
16393 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16394 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16395 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16396
16397 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16398 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16399 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16400 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16401
16402 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16403 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16404 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16405 packets only):
16406 17: Session Expiry Interval
16407 33: Receive Maximum
16408 39: Maximum Packet Size
16409 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16410 25: Request Response Information
16411 23: Request Problem Information
16412 21: Authentication Method
16413 22: Authentication Data
16414 18: Will Delay Interval
16415 1: Payload Format Indicator
16416 2: Message Expiry Interval
16417 3: Content Type
16418 8: Response Topic
16419 9: Correlation Data
16420 Not supported yet:
16421 38: User Property
16422
16423 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16424 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16425 packets only):
16426 17: Session Expiry Interval
16427 33: Receive Maximum
16428 36: Maximum QoS
16429 37: Retain Available
16430 39: Maximum Packet Size
16431 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16432 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16433 31: Reason String
16434 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16435 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16436 42: Shared Subscription Available
16437 19: Server Keep Alive
16438 26: Response Information
16439 28: Server Reference
16440 21: Authentication Method
16441 22: Authentication Data
16442 Not supported yet:
16443 38: User Property
16444
16445 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16446 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16447 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16448 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16449
16450 Example:
16451
16452 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16453 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16454 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16455 if data_in_buffer
16456 # do the same as above
16457 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16458 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16459 if data_in_buffer
16460
16461mqtt_is_valid
16462 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16463
16464 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16465 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16466 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16467 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16468
16469 Example:
16470
16471 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16472 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16473
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016474mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016475 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016476 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16477 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016478 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016479 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016480 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016481 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16482 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16484 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016485 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016486 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016487
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016488nbsrv
16489 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16490 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16491 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16492 map lookup.
16493
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016494neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016495 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16496 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16497 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16498 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016499
16500not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016501 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016502 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016503 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016504 absence of a flag).
16505
16506odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016507 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016508 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16509
16510or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016511 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016512 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016513 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16514 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016515 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016516 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16517 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16518 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16519 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016520 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016521 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016522
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016523protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16524 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16525 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16526 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16527 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16528 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16529 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16530 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16531 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16532 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16533 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16534 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16535
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016536regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016537 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16538 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16539 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16540 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16541 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16542 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16543 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16544 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16545 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016546 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16547 of characters with other ones.
16548
16549 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16550 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16551 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16552 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16553 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16554 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016555
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016556 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016557
16558 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16559 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16560 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016561 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016562
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016563 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16564 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16565
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016566 # capture groups and backreferences
16567 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016568 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016569 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16570
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016571capture-req(<id>)
16572 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16573 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16574
16575 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016576 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16577 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016578
16579capture-res(<id>)
16580 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16581 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16582
16583 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016584 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16585 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016586
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016587rtrim(<chars>)
16588 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16589 of the input sample.
16590
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016591sdbm([<avalanche>])
16592 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16593 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16594 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16595 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16596 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16597 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16598 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016599 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16600 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016601
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016602secure_memcmp(<var>)
16603 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16604 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16605 match.
16606
16607 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16608 performed in constant time.
16609
16610 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16611 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16612
16613 Example :
16614
16615 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16616 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16617 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16618 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16619
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016620set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016621 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16622 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16623 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016624 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016625 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16626 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016627 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016628 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16629 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016630 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016631 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016632
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016633sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016634 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016635 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16636
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016637sha2([<bits>])
16638 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16639 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16640
16641 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16642 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16643
16644 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16645 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16646
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016647srv_queue
16648 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16649 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16650 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16651 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16652 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16653
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016654strcmp(<var>)
16655 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16656 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16657 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16658 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16659 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16660 shorter).
16661
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016662 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16663 strings in constant time.
16664
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016665 Example :
16666
16667 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16668 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16669 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16670
16671
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016672sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016673 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16674 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016675 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016676 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16677 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016681 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016686
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016687table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16688 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16689 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16690 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16691 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16692 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16693 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16694
16695
16696table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16699 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16700 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16701 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16702 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16703
16704table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16705 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16706 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016707 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016708 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16709 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16710
16711table_conn_cur(<table>)
16712 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16713 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16714 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16715 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16716 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16717
16718table_conn_rate(<table>)
16719 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16720 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16721 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16722 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16723 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16724
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016725table_gpt0(<table>)
16726 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16727 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16728 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16729 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16730 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16731
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016732table_gpc0(<table>)
16733 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16734 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16735 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16736 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16737 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16738
16739table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16742 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16743 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16744 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16745 sample fetch keyword.
16746
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016747table_gpc1(<table>)
16748 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16749 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16750 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16751 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16752 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16753
16754table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16757 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16758 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16759 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16760 sample fetch keyword.
16761
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016762table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016765 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016766 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16767 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16768
16769table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16770 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16771 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16772 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16773 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16774 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16775 keyword.
16776
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016777table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16781 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16782 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16783
16784table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16787 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16788 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16789 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16790 keyword.
16791
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016792table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16793 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16794 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016795 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016796 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16797 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16798
16799table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16800 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16801 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16802 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16803 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16804 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16805 keyword.
16806
16807table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16808 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16809 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016810 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016811 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16812 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16813 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16814 keyword.
16815
16816table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016820 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16821 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16822 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16823 keyword.
16824
16825table_server_id(<table>)
16826 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16827 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16828 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16829 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16830 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16831 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16832
16833table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16834 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16835 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016836 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016837 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16838 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16839 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16840 keyword.
16841
16842table_sess_rate(<table>)
16843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16845 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16846 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16847 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16848 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16849 keyword.
16850
16851table_trackers(<table>)
16852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16855 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16856 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16857 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16858 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16859 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16860 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16861 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16862
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016863ub64dec
16864 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16865 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16866 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16867
16868 Example:
16869 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16870 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16871
16872ub64enc
16873 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16874
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016875upper
16876 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16877 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16878 type. The result is of type string.
16879
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016880url_dec([<in_form>])
16881 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16882 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16883 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16884 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16885 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16886 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016887
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016888url_enc([<enc_type>])
16889 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16890 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16891 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16892 optional argument is here for future changes.
16893
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016894ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016895 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016896 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16897 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16898 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016899 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16900 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16901 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16902 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016903 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016904 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16905 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016906
16907 Example:
16908 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16909 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16910
16911 message Point {
16912 int32 latitude = 1;
16913 int32 longitude = 2;
16914 }
16915
16916 message PPoint {
16917 Point point = 59;
16918 }
16919
16920 message Rectangle {
16921 // One corner of the rectangle.
16922 PPoint lo = 48;
16923 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16924 PPoint hi = 49;
16925 }
16926
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016927 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16928 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16929 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016930
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016931 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16932 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016933 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016934 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16935
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016936 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016937
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016938 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016939
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016940 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16941 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16942 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016943
16944 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16945 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16946 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16947
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016948 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16949 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16950 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016951
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016952
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016953unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016954 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16955 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16958 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16959 response),
16960 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16961 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16962 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16963 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16964
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016965utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16966 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16967 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16968 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16969 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16970 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16971 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16972
16973 Example :
16974
16975 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016976 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016977 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16978
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016979word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16980 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16981 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16982 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016983 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016984 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16985 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16986
16987 Example :
16988 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16989 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16990 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16991 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16992 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016993 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016994
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016995wt6([<avalanche>])
16996 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16997 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16998 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16999 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17000 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17001 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17002 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017003 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17004 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017005
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017006xor(<value>)
17007 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017008 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017009 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017010 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017011 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017012 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17013 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017014 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017015 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17016 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017017 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017018 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017019
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017020xxh3([<seed>])
17021 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17022 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17023 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17024 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17025 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17026 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17027 considered as cryptographically secure.
17028
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017029xxh32([<seed>])
17030 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17031 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17032 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17033 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17034 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17035 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17036 as cryptographically secure.
17037
17038xxh64([<seed>])
17039 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17040 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17041 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17042 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17043 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17044 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17045 as cryptographically secure.
17046
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017047
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170487.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017049--------------------------------------------
17050
17051A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17052not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17053"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17054The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17055
17056always_false : boolean
17057 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17058 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17059
17060always_true : boolean
17061 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17062 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17063
17064avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017065 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17067 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17068 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17069 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17070 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17071 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17072 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17073 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17074 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17075 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17076 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17077 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17078 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017081 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17082 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17083 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17084 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017085 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17086
17087be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17089 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17090 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17091 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17092 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017093 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17094 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017095
17096 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17097 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17098 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017100be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17101 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17102 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17103 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017104 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017105 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17106 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017107
17108 Example :
17109 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17110 backend dynamic
17111 mode http
17112 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17113 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017114
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017115bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017116 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17117 of the string.
17118
17119bool(<bool>) : bool
17120 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17121 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017123connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17124 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017125 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017126 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17127 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017128
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017129 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017130 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017131 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17132
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017133 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17134 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017135
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017136 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017137 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017139 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017140 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017141 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017142 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017143
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017144 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17145 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017147 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017148
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017149cpu_calls : integer
17150 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17151 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17152 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17153 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17154 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17155 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17156
17157cpu_ns_avg : integer
17158 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17159 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17160 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17161 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17162 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17163 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17164 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17165 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17166 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17167 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17168 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17169
17170cpu_ns_tot : integer
17171 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17172 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17173 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17174 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17175 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17176 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17177 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17178 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17179 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17180 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17181 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17182 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17183 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17184
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017185date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017186 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017187
17188 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17189 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17190 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017191 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17192
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017193 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17194 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17195 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17196 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17197 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17198
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017199 Example :
17200
17201 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17202 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017203
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017204 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17205 # millisecond granularity
17206 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17207
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017208date_us : integer
17209 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17210 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17211 from the same timeval structure.
17212
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017213distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17214 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17215 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17216 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17217 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17218 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17219 list of supported tokens.
17220
17221distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17222 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17223 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17224 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17225 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17226 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17227 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17228 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17229 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17230 supported tokens.
17231
17232 Example :
17233 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17234 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17235 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17236 # send large files to the big farm
17237 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17238
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017239env(<name>) : string
17240 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17241 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17242 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17243 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17244 certain way.
17245
17246 Examples :
17247 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17248 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17249
17250 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17251 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017253fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17254 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017255 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17256 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17258 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017259 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017260 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17261 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017262
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017263fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17264 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17265 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17266 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017268fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17269 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17270 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17271 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17272 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17273 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17274 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17275 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17276 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017277
17278 Example :
17279 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17280 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17281 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17282 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17283 frontend mail
17284 bind :25
17285 mode tcp
17286 maxconn 100
17287 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17288 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17289 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17290 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017291
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017292hostname : string
17293 Returns the system hostname.
17294
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017295int(<integer>) : signed integer
17296 Returns a signed integer.
17297
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017298ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17299 Returns an ipv4.
17300
17301ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17302 Returns an ipv6.
17303
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017304lat_ns_avg : integer
17305 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17306 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17307 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17308 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17309 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17310 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17311 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17312 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17313 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017314 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17315 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17316 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17317 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17318 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17319 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017320
17321lat_ns_tot : integer
17322 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17323 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17324 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17325 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17326 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17327 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17328 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17329 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17330 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017331 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17332 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17333 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17334 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17335 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017336 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17337 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17338 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17339 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17340 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17341 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17342
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017343meth(<method>) : method
17344 Returns a method.
17345
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017346nbproc : integer
17347 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17348 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17349 and debugging purposes.
17350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17353 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17354 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017355 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17356 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17357 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017358
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017359prio_class : integer
17360 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17361 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17362 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17363
17364prio_offset : integer
17365 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17366 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17367 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17368 set-priority-offset".
17369
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017370proc : integer
17371 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17372 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17373 debugging purposes.
17374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017376 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17377 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17378 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17380 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17381 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17382 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17383 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17384
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017385rand([<range>]) : integer
17386 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17387 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17388 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17389 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17390 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17391
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017392uuid([<version>]) : string
17393 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17394 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17395 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17399 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17400 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17401 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17402 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017403 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17404 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17405
17406srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17407 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17408 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17409 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17410 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17411 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17412 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17413 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17414
17415 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17416 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417
17418srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17419 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17420 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17421 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017422 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17424 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17425 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17426
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017427srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17428 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17429 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17430 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17431 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17432 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17433 fetch methods.
17434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017435srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17436 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17437 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017438 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17440 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017441 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442 overloading servers).
17443
17444 Example :
17445 # Redirect to a separate back
17446 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17447 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17448 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17449
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017450srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017451 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17452 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17453 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17454
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017455srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017456 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17457 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17458 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17459
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017460srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017461 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17462 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17463 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17464
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017465stopping : boolean
17466 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17467 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17468 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17469
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017470str(<string>) : string
17471 Returns a string.
17472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17474 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17475 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17476
17477table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17478 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17479 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17480 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17481
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017482thread : integer
17483 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17484 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17485 and debugging purposes.
17486
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017487var(<var-name>) : undefined
17488 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017489 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17490 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017491 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017492 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17493 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017494 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017495 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17496 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017498 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017499
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175007.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017501----------------------------------
17502
17503The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17504closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17505methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17506sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17507TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017508the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17509counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017510"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17511used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17512can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17513Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17514table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17515tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17516currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017518bc_dst : ip
17519 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17520 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17521 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17522 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17523
17524bc_dst_port : integer
17525 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17526 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17527
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017528bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017529 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17530 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17531 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17532
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017533bc_src : ip
17534 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17535 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17536 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17537 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17538
17539bc_src_port : integer
17540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17541 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017543be_id : integer
17544 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017545 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17546 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017548be_name : string
17549 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017550 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17551 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017552
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017553be_server_timeout : integer
17554 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17555 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17556 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17557
17558be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17559 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17560 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17561 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17562
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017563cur_server_timeout : integer
17564 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17565 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17566 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17567
17568cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17569 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17570 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17571 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573dst : ip
17574 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17575 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17576 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17577 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017578 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17579 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17580 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17581 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17582 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17583 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017584
17585dst_conn : integer
17586 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17587 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17588 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17589 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17590 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17591 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17592 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17593 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017594
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017595dst_is_local : boolean
17596 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17597 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17598 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17599 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017600 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017601 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17602 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17603 it only once per connection.
17604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017605dst_port : integer
17606 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17607 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17608 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17609 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17610 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17611 an HTTP header.
17612
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017613fc_http_major : integer
17614 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17615 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17616 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17617
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017618fc_pp_authority : string
17619 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17620 if any.
17621
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017622fc_pp_unique_id : string
17623 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17624 if any.
17625
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017626fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17627 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17628 header.
17629
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017630fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17631 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17632 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17633 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17634 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17635 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17636 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17637
17638fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17639 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17640 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17641 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17642 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17643 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17644 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17645
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017646fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017647 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17648 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17649 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17650 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17651
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017652fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017653 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17654 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17655 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17656 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17657
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017658fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017659 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17660 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17661 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17662 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17663
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017664fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017665 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17666 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17667 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17668 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17669
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017670fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017671 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17672 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17673 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17674 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17675
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017676fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017677 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17678 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17679 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17680 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17681
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017682fe_defbe : string
17683 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17684 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017686fe_id : integer
17687 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017688 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17690
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017691fe_name : string
17692 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17693 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17694 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17695
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017696fe_client_timeout : integer
17697 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17698 current frontend.
17699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017700sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017701sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17702sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17703sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017704 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17705 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17706 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17707
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017708sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017709sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17710sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17711sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017712 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17713 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17714 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17715
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017716sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017717sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17718sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17719sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017720 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17721 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017722 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17723 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17724 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017725
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017726 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017727 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17728 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017729 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17730 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17731 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017732 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17733 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17734
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017735sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17736sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17737sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17738sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17739 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17740 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17741 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17742 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17743 when a first ACL was verified.
17744
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017745sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017746sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17747sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17748sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017749 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017750 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017752sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017753sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17754sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17755sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017756 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17757 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17758 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17759
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017760sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017761sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17762sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17763sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017764 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17765 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17766 See also src_conn_rate.
17767
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017768sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017769sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17770sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17771sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017772 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017773 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017774
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017775sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17776sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17777sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17778sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17779 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17780 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17781
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017782sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17783sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17784sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17785sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17786 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17787 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17788
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017789sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017790sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17791sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17792sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017793 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17794 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17795 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017796 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17797 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17798 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017799
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017800sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17801sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17802sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17803sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17804 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17805 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17806 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17807 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17808 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17809 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017811sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017812sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17813sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17814sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017815 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017816 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17817 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017819sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017820sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17821sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17822sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017823 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17824 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17825 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17826 src_http_err_rate.
17827
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017828sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17829sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17830sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17831sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17832 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17833 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17834 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17835
17836sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17837sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17838sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17839sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17840 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17841 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17842 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17843 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017845sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017846sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17847sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17848sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017849 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017850 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17851 src_http_req_cnt.
17852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017853sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017854sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17855sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17856sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017857 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17858 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17859 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17860 src_http_req_rate.
17861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017862sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017863sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17864sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17865sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017866 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017867 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17868 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17869 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17870 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017871
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017872 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017873 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17874 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017875 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17876
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017877sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17878sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17879sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17880sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17881 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17882 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17883 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17884 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17885 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017887sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017888sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17889sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17890sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017891 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17892 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17893 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017894
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017895sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017896sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17897sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17898sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017899 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17900 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17901 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017902
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017903sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017904sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17905sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17906sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017907 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017908 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17909 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17910 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017911 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017912 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17913
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017914sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017915sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17916sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17917sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017918 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17919 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17920 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17921 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17922 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017923 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017924
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017925sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017926sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17927sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17928sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017929 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17930 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17931 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17932
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017933sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017934sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17935sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17936sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017937 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17938 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017939 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017940 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17941 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17943 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17944 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946so_id : integer
17947 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17948 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17949 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017950
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017951so_name : string
17952 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17953 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17954 strings instead of integers.
17955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017956src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017957 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17959 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17960 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017961 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17962 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17963 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017964 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17965 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17966 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17967 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17968 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17969 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17970 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017971
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017972 Example:
17973 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17974 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17977 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17978 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17979 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017980 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17983 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17984 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017985 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017986 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17989 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17990 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17991 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17992 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17993 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17994 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017995
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017996 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017997 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17998 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17999 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18000 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018001 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018002 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18003 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18004
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018005src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18006 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18007 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18008 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18009 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18010 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18011 was verified.
18012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018014 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018015 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018016 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018017 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018019src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018020 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018021 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18022 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018023 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18026 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18027 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18028 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018029 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018032 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018034 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018035 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018036
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018037src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18038 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18039 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18040 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18041 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18042
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018043src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18044 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18045 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18046 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18047 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018049src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018050 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018051 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018052 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18053 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018054 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18055 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18056 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018057
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018058src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18059 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18060 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18061 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18062 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18063 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18064 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18065 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018067src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018068 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018069 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018070 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018071 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018072 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18075 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18076 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18077 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18078 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018079 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018080
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018081src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18082 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18083 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018084 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018085 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18086 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18087
18088src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18089 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18090 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18091 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18092 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18093 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18094 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018096src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018097 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018098 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18099 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018100 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018102src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18103 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18104 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18105 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018106 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018107 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018109src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18110 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18111 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18112 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018113 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018114 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18115 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018116
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018117 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018118 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018119 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018120 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018121
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018122src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18123 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18124 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18125 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18126 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18127 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18128 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18129
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018130src_is_local : boolean
18131 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18132 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18133 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18134 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018135 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018136 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18137 once per connection.
18138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018139src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018140 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18141 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18142 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18143 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18144 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018146src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018147 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18148 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18149 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18150 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18151 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153src_port : integer
18154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18155 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18156 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18157 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018159src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018160 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018161 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18162 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18163 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018164 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18167 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18168 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18169 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18170 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018171 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18174 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18175 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18176 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18177 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18178 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18179 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18180 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18181 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018182
18183 Example :
18184 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18185 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18186 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18187 listen ssh
18188 bind :22
18189 mode tcp
18190 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018191 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018193 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195srv_id : integer
18196 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18197 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018198 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018199
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018200srv_name : string
18201 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18202 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018203 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182057.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018206----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18209closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18210when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18211usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018212future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018213
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001821451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18215 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18216 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18217 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18218 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18219 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18220
18221 Example :
18222 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18223 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18224 # the request.
18225 frontend http-in
18226 bind *:8081
18227 default_backend servers
18228 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18229 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18230
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018231ssl_bc : boolean
18232 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18233 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018234 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18235 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018236
18237ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18238 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018239 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18240 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018241
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018242ssl_bc_alpn : string
18243 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18244 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018245 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018246 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18247 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18248 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18249 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18250 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018251 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18252 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018253
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018254ssl_bc_cipher : string
18255 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018256 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18257 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018258
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018259ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18260 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18261 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18262 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018263 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018264
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018265ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18266 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18267 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018268 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18269 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018270
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018271ssl_bc_npn : string
18272 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18273 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018274 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018275 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18276 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18277 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18278 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018279 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18280 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018281
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018282ssl_bc_protocol : string
18283 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018284 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18285 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018286
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018287ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018288 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018289 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018290 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18291 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018292
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018293ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18294 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18295 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18296 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018297 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018298
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018299ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18300 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18301 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018302 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18303 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018304
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018305ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18306 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18307 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18308 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018309 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018310
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018311ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18312 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018313 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18314 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18317 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18318 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18319 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18320 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18321 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18324 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18325 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18326 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18327 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018328
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018329ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018330 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18331 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18332 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018333 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018334 does not support resumed sessions.
18335
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018336ssl_c_der : binary
18337 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18338 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18339 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018341ssl_c_err : integer
18342 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18343 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18344 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18345 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18346 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018347
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018348ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018349 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18350 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18351 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18352 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18353 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18354 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18355 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18356 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018357 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18358 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18359 LDAP v3.
18360 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18361 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018363ssl_c_key_alg : string
18364 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18365 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18366 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368ssl_c_notafter : string
18369 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18370 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18371 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018373ssl_c_notbefore : string
18374 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18375 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18376 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018377
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018378ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018379 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18380 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18381 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18382 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18383 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18384 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18385 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18386 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018387 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18388 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18389 LDAP v3.
18390 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18391 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393ssl_c_serial : binary
18394 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18395 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18396 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018398ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18399 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18400 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18401 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018402 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18403 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18404
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018405 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018406 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18409 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18410 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18411 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018413ssl_c_used : boolean
18414 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18415 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417ssl_c_verify : integer
18418 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18419 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18420 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18421 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423ssl_c_version : integer
18424 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18425 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018426
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018427ssl_f_der : binary
18428 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18429 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18430 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18431
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018432ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18434 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18435 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18436 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018437 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18439 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18440 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018441 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18442 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18443 LDAP v3.
18444 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18445 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018447ssl_f_key_alg : string
18448 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18449 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18450 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452ssl_f_notafter : string
18453 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18454 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18455 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457ssl_f_notbefore : string
18458 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18459 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18460 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018461
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018462ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018463 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18464 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18465 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18466 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18467 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18468 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18469 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18470 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018471 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18472 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18473 LDAP v3.
18474 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18475 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477ssl_f_serial : binary
18478 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18479 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18480 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018481
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018482ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18483 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18484 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18485 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018487ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18488 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18489 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18490 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018492ssl_f_version : integer
18493 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18494 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18495
18496ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018497 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18498 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18499 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018501 Example :
18502 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18503 listen http-https
18504 bind :80
18505 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18506 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18507
18508ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18509 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18510 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18511
18512ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018513 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018514 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18515 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18516 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18517 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18518 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18519 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18520 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18521 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018523ssl_fc_cipher : string
18524 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18525 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018526
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018527ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18528 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18529 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018530 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018531
18532ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18533 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18534 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018535 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018536
18537ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18538 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18539 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18540 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018541 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018542 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018543
18544ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18545 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18546 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018547 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018548
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018549ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18550 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18551 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18552 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18553
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018554ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18555 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18556 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18557 transport layer.
18558 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18559 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18560 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18561 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18562
18563ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18564 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18565 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18566 transport layer.
18567 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18568 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18569 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18570 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18571
18572ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18573 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18574 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18575 transport layer.
18576 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18577 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18578 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18579 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18580
18581ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18582 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18583 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18584 transport layer.
18585 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18586 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18587 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18588 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18589
18590ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18591 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18592 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18593 transport layer.
18594 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18595 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18596 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18597 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018600 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18601 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018602 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18603 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18604 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18605 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018606
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018607ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18608 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18609 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18610 wait until the handshake happened.
18611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018612ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18613 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018614 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18615 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018616 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018617 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018618
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018619ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018620 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018621 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18622 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018624ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018625 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018626 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18627 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18628 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18629 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18630 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18631 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18632 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634ssl_fc_protocol : string
18635 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18636 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018637
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018638ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018639 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018640 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18641 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018642
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018643ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18644 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18645 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18646 transport layer.
18647 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18648 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18649 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18650 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18651
18652ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18653 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18654 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18655 transport layer.
18656 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18657 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18658 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18659 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18660
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018661ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18662 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18663 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18664 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018666ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18667 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18668 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18669 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18670 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018671
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018672ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18673 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18674 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18675 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18676 BoringSSL.
18677
18678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018679ssl_fc_sni : string
18680 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18681 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18682 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18683 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18684 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18685
18686 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18687 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18688 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018689 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018690 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018692 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18694 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18697 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18698 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018699
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018700ssl_s_der : binary
18701 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18702 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18703 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18704
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018705ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18706 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18707 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18708 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018709 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018710 does not support resumed sessions.
18711
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018712ssl_s_key_alg : string
18713 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18714 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18715 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18716
18717ssl_s_notafter : string
18718 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18719 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18720 transport layer.
18721
18722ssl_s_notbefore : string
18723 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18724 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18725 transport layer.
18726
18727ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18728 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18729 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18730 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18731 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18732 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18733 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018734 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18735 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018736 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18737 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18738 LDAP v3.
18739 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18740 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18741
18742ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18743 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18744 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18745 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18746 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18747 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18748 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018749 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18750 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018751 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18752 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18753 LDAP v3.
18754 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18755 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18756
18757ssl_s_serial : binary
18758 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18759 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18760 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18761
18762ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18763 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18764 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18765 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18766
18767ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18768 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18769 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18770 layer.
18771
18772ssl_s_version : integer
18773 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18774 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018779Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18780sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18781only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18782For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18783be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18784can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18785sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18786for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18787content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018788
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018789Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18790 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18791 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18792 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18793 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18794 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18795 sample expression). So be careful.
18796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018798 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18800 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18803 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018804 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807req.len : integer
18808req_len : integer (deprecated)
18809 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18810 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18811 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18812 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18813 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18814 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18815 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18816 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18819 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018820 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18821 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18822 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18823 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 ACL alternatives :
18826 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18829 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18830 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18831 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18832 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834 ACL alternatives :
18835 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018839req.proto_http : boolean
18840req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18841 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18842 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18843 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18844 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18845 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18846 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18847 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018849 Example:
18850 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18851 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18852 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018853 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18856rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18857 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18858 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18859 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18860 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18861 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18862 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18863 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18866 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18867 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18868 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18869 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18870 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872 ACL derivatives :
18873 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875 Example :
18876 listen tse-farm
18877 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18878 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18879 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18880 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18881 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18882 persist rdp-cookie
18883 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18884 # This is only useful makes sense if
18885 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18886 stick-table type string size 204800
18887 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18888 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18889 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018891 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18892 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018894req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18895rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18896 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18897 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18898 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18899 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901 ACL derivatives :
18902 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018903
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018904req.ssl_alpn : string
18905 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18906 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18907 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18908 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18909 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18910 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018911 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018912
18913 Examples :
18914 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18915 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18916 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018917 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018918 default_backend bk_default
18919
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018920req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18921 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18922 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018923 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18924 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18925 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18926 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18927 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018929req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18930req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18931 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18932 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18933 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18934 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18935 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18936 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18937 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939req.ssl_sni : string
18940req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18941 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18942 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18943 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18944 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18945 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018946 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18947 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18948 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18949 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18950 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18951 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18952 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18953 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18954 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956 ACL derivatives :
18957 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018959 Examples :
18960 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18961 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18962 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18963 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18964 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018965
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018966req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18967 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18968 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18969 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18970 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18971 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18972 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18973 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18974 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18975 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977req.ssl_ver : integer
18978req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18979 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18980 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18981 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18982 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18983 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18984 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18985 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018986 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018989 ACL derivatives :
18990 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018991
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018992res.len : integer
18993 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18994 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18995 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18996 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18997 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18998 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18999 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019000 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019002res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19003 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019004 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019005 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019006 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019007 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019009res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19010 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19011 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19012 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019013 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19014 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019016 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019017
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019018res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19019rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19020 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19021 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19022 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19023 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19024 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19025 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19026 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019028wait_end : boolean
19029 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19030 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019031 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19033 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019034 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019035 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19036 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019038 Examples :
19039 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19040 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19041 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019043 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19044 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19045 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19046 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19047 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19048 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19049 tcp-request content reject
19050
19051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190527.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053--------------------------------------
19054
19055It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19056This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19057data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19058its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19059HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19060content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19061to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19062more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19063response are indexed.
19064
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019065Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19066 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19067 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19068 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19069 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19070 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19071 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019073base : string
19074 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19075 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19076 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19077 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19078 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19079 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19080 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19081 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19082
19083 ACL derivatives :
19084 base : exact string match
19085 base_beg : prefix match
19086 base_dir : subdir match
19087 base_dom : domain match
19088 base_end : suffix match
19089 base_len : length match
19090 base_reg : regex match
19091 base_sub : substring match
19092
19093base32 : integer
19094 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19095 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19096 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019097 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19098 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19099 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019100
19101base32+src : binary
19102 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19103 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19104 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19105 per-URL counters.
19106
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019107baseq : string
19108 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19109 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19110 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19111 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19112
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019113capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19114 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19115 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19116 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19117
19118capture.req.method : string
19119 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19120 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19121 because it's allocated.
19122
19123capture.req.uri : string
19124 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19125 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19126 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19127 allocated.
19128
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019129capture.req.ver : string
19130 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19131 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19132 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19133
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019134capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19135 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19136 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19137 The first entry is an index of 0.
19138 See also: "capture response header"
19139
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019140capture.res.ver : string
19141 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19142 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19143 persistent flag.
19144
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019145req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019146 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19147 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19148 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019149
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019150req.body_param([<name>) : string
19151 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19152 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19153 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19154 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19155 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19156 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19157 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19158 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19159 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19160 given.
19161
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019162req.body_len : integer
19163 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19164 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019165 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19166 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019167
19168req.body_size : integer
19169 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019170 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19171 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173req.cook([<name>]) : string
19174cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19175 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19176 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19177 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19178 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19179 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19180 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19181 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19182 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19183
19184 ACL derivatives :
19185 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19186 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19187 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19188 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19189 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19190 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19191 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19192 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019194req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19195cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19196 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19197 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019199req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19200cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19201 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19202 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19203 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19204 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019206cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19207 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19208 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19209 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19210 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019211 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019212 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19213 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19214 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19215 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019217hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19218 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19219 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19220 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19221 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019222 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019225 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19226 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19227 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19228 with headers such as User-Agent.
19229
19230 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19231 found.
19232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019233 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19234 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19235 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019236 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19239 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19240 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019241 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19242 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019245 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19246 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19247 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19248 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19249 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19250 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19251 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19252
19253 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19254 found.
19255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019256 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19257 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19258 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019259 with -1 being the last one.
19260
19261 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19262 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019264 ACL derivatives :
19265 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19266 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19267 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19268 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19269 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19270 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19271 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19272 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19273
19274req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19275hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19276 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19277 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019278 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19279 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19280 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19281
19282 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19283 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19284 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19285
19286 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019287
19288req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19289hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19290 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19291 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19292 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019293 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19294 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19295 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19296 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19297 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019298
19299 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19300
19301 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302
19303req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19304hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19305 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19306 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19307 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019308
19309 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19310
19311 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019312
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019313req.hdrs : string
19314 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19315 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19316 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19317 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19318
19319req.hdrs_bin : binary
19320 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19321 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19322 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19323 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19324 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19325 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19326
19327 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019328
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019329 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19330 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019332http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19333 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19334 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19335 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19336 basic auth is supported.
19337
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019338http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19339 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19340 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19341 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19342 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19344 basic auth is supported.
19345
19346 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019347 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19348 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19349 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19350 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019352http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019353 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19354 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19355 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019356
19357http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019358 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19359 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19360 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019361
19362http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019363 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19364 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19365 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019367http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019368 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19369 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19371 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019373method : integer + string
19374 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19375 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19376 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19377 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19378 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19379 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19380 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019382 ACL derivatives :
19383 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019385 Example :
19386 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19387 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19388 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019390path : string
19391 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19392 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19393 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19394 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19395 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019396 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019397 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019399 ACL derivatives :
19400 path : exact string match
19401 path_beg : prefix match
19402 path_dir : subdir match
19403 path_dom : domain match
19404 path_end : suffix match
19405 path_len : length match
19406 path_reg : regex match
19407 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019408
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019409pathq : string
19410 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19411 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19412 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19413 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19414 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19415 result in both cases.
19416
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019417query : string
19418 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19419 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19420 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19421 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019422 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019423 which stops before the question mark.
19424
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019425req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19426 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19427 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19428 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19429 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019431req.ver : string
19432req_ver : string (deprecated)
19433 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19434 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19435 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437 ACL derivatives :
19438 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019439
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019440res.body : binary
19441 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19442 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019443 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19444
19445 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019446
19447res.body_len : integer
19448 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19449 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019450 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19451
19452 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019453
19454res.body_size : integer
19455 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19456 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19457 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19458 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019459 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19460
19461 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019462
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019463res.cache_hit : boolean
19464 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19465 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19466
19467res.cache_name : string
19468 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19469 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19470 empty string.
19471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019472res.comp : boolean
19473 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19474 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19475 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477res.comp_algo : string
19478 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19479 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19480 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482res.cook([<name>]) : string
19483scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19484 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19485 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019486 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19487
19488 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490 ACL derivatives :
19491 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019493res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19494scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19495 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19496 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019497 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19498
19499 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019501res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19502scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19503 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19504 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019505 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19506
19507 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019509res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019510 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19511 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19512
19513 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19514 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19515
19516 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19517
19518 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019521 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19522 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19523
19524 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19525 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19526
19527 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019529res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19530shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019531 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19532 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19533
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019534 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019535 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19536
19537 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539 ACL derivatives :
19540 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19541 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19542 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19543 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19544 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19545 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19546 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19547 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19548
19549res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19550shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019551 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19552 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19553
19554 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019555 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019556
19557 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19560shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019561 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19562 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19563
19564 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19565
19566 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019567
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019568res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19569 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19570 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19571 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019572 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19573
19574 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19577shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019578 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19579 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19580
19581 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19582
19583 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019584
19585res.hdrs : string
19586 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19587 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19588 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019589 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19590
19591 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019592
19593res.hdrs_bin : binary
19594 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19595 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19596 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19597 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19598 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19599 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19600 (length of 0 for both).
19601
19602 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19603
19604 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19605 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019607res.ver : string
19608resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19609 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019610 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19611
19612 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019614 ACL derivatives :
19615 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019617set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19618 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19619 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019620 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019621 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19624 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019626status : integer
19627 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19628 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019629 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19630
19631 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019632
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019633unique-id : string
19634 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19635 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19636 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19637 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19638 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19639 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019641url : string
19642 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19643 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19644 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19645 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19646 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19647 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19648 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019650 ACL derivatives :
19651 url : exact string match
19652 url_beg : prefix match
19653 url_dir : subdir match
19654 url_dom : domain match
19655 url_end : suffix match
19656 url_len : length match
19657 url_reg : regex match
19658 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019660url_ip : ip
19661 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19662 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19663 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19664 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19665 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19666 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19667 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669url_port : integer
19670 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19671 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19672 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19673 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019674
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019675urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19676url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019677 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19678 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019679 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19680 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19681 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19682 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019683 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19684 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019685 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19686 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019688 ACL derivatives :
19689 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19690 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19691 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19692 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19693 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19694 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19695 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19696 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019697
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019699 Example :
19700 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19701 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19702 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19703 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019704
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019705urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019706 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19707 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19708 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019709
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019710url32 : integer
19711 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19712 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19713 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19714 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19715 is an unsigned integer.
19716
19717url32+src : binary
19718 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19719 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19720 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19721
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019722
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197237.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019724---------------------------------------
19725
19726This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19727used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19728purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19729There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19730or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19731any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19732for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19733
19734internal.htx.data : integer
19735 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19736 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19737
19738internal.htx.free : integer
19739 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19740 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19741
19742internal.htx.free_data : integer
19743 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19744 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19745
19746internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019747 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19748 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19749 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019750
19751internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19752 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19753 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19754
19755internal.htx.size : integer
19756 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19757 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19758
19759internal.htx.used : integer
19760 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19761 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19762 direction.
19763
19764internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19765 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19766 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19767 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19768 of the special value :
19769 * head : The oldest inserted block
19770 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019771 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019772
19773internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19774 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19775 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19776 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19777 integer or one of the special value :
19778 * head : The oldest inserted block
19779 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019780 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019781
19782internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19783 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19784 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19785 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19786 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19787
19788 * head : The oldest inserted block
19789 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019790 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019791
19792internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19793 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19794 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19795 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19796 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19797
19798 * head : The oldest inserted block
19799 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019800 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019801
19802internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19803 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19804 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19805 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19806 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19807
19808 * head : The oldest inserted block
19809 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019810 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019811
19812internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19813 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19814 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19815 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19816 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19817
19818 * head : The oldest inserted block
19819 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019820 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019821
19822internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19823 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19824 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19825 it returns false.
19826
19827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198287.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019829---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019831Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19832every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019833order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019835ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019836---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19837FALSE always_false never match
19838HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19839HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19840HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019841HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019842HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19843HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19844HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19845HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19846LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19847METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19848METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19849METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19850METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19851METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19852METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19853METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19854METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19855RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19856REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19857TRUE always_true always match
19858WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19859---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019860
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198628. Logging
19863----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019864
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019865One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19866provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19867very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19868provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19869state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019870to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019871headers.
19872
19873In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19874about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19875send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19876
19877 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19878 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19879 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19880 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19881 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019882 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019883 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019884
19885The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19886allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19887as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19888while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19889real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19890delay.
19891
19892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198938.1. Log levels
19894---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019895
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019896TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019897source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019898HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19899in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19900track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19901syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19902about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019903
19904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199058.2. Log formats
19906----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019907
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019908HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019909and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19910slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19911options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912
19913 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19914 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19915 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19916 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19917 extents.
19918
19919 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19920 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19921 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19922 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19923 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19924
19925 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19926 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19927 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19928 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19929 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19930
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019931 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19932 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19933 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19934 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19935
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019936 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019938Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19939specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19940field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19941servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19942always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19943identifier.
19944
19945Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19946 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19947 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19948 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19949 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19950
19951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199528.2.1. Default log format
19953-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019954
19955This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19956as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19957format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19958
19959 Example :
19960 listen www
19961 mode http
19962 log global
19963 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19964
19965 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19966 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19967 (www/HTTP)
19968
19969 Field Format Extract from the example above
19970 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19971 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19972 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19973 4 'to' to
19974 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19975 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19976
19977Detailed fields description :
19978 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19979 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19980 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19981 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19982 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19983 and processed the connection.
19984 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19985
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019986In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19987"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19988connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019990It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19991will eventually disappear.
19992
19993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199948.2.2. TCP log format
19995---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019996
19997The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19998is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19999information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20000counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20001emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20002environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20003the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20004sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020005specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20006not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20007fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20008marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020009
20010 Example :
20011 frontend fnt
20012 mode tcp
20013 option tcplog
20014 log global
20015 default_backend bck
20016
20017 backend bck
20018 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20019
20020 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20021 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20022 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20023
20024 Field Format Extract from the example above
20025 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20026 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20027 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20028 4 frontend_name fnt
20029 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20030 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20031 7 bytes_read* 212
20032 8 termination_state --
20033 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20034 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20035
20036Detailed fields description :
20037 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020038 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20039 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20040 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020041 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020042 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020043 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020044
20045 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020046 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20047 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20048 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020049
20050 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20051 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20052 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020053 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20054 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20055 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20056 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020057
20058 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20059 and processed the connection.
20060
20061 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20062 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20063 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20064 applications.
20065
20066 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20067 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20068 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20069 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20070 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20071
20072 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20073 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20074 See "Timers" below for more details.
20075
20076 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20077 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20078 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20079 "Timers" below for more details.
20080
20081 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020082 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020083 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20084 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20085 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20086 details.
20087
20088 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20089 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20090 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20091 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20092 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20093
20094 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20095 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20096 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20097 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20098 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20099 for more details.
20100
20101 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020102 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20104 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20105 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020106 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020107
20108 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20109 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20110 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20111 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20112 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20113 caused by a denial of service attack.
20114
20115 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20116 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20117 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20118 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20119 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20120 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20121 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20122 denial of service attack.
20123
20124 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20125 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20126 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20127 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20128 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20129 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20130 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20131 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20132 be processed than on other servers.
20133
20134 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20135 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20136 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20137 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20138 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20139 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20140 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20141 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20142 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20143 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20144 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20145 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20146 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20147
20148 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20149 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20150 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20151 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20152 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20153 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020154 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020155 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20156
20157 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20158 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20159 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20160 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20161 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20162 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020163 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020164 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20165 occurs.
20166
20167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201688.2.3. HTTP log format
20169----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020170
20171The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20172is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20173the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20174are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20175emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20176generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20177"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20178which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020179frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20180is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020181
20182Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20183slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20184with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20185
20186 Example :
20187 frontend http-in
20188 mode http
20189 option httplog
20190 log global
20191 default_backend bck
20192
20193 backend static
20194 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20195
20196 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20197 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20198 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020199 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020200
20201 Field Format Extract from the example above
20202 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20203 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020204 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020205 4 frontend_name http-in
20206 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020207 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020208 7 status_code 200
20209 8 bytes_read* 2750
20210 9 captured_request_cookie -
20211 10 captured_response_cookie -
20212 11 termination_state ----
20213 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20214 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20215 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20216 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20217 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020218
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219Detailed fields description :
20220 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020221 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20222 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20223 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020224 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020225 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020226 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020227
20228 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020229 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20230 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20231 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020232
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020233 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20234 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020235
20236 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20237 and processed the connection.
20238
20239 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20240 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20241 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20242
20243 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20244 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20245 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20246 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20247 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20248 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20249
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020250 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20251 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20252 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020253 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020254 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20255 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020256 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20257 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020258
20259 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20260 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020261 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262
20263 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20264 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020265 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20266 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020267
20268 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20269 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20270 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20271 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20272 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020273 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20274 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020275
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020276 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20277 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20278 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20279 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20280 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20281 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20282 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020283 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284
20285 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20286 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20287 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20288
20289 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20290 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020291 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020292 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20293 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20294 overflowing.
20295
20296 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20297 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20298 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20299 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20300 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20301 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20302 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20303 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20304
20305 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20306 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20307 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20308 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20309 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20310 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20311 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20312 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20313
20314 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20315 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20316 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20317 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20318 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20319 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20320 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20321
20322 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020323 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020324 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20325 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20326 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020327 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020328 system.
20329
20330 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20331 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20332 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20333 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20334 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20335 caused by a denial of service attack.
20336
20337 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20338 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20339 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20340 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20341 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20342 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20343 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20344 denial of service attack.
20345
20346 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20347 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20348 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20349 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20350 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20351 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20352 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20353 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20354 processed than on other servers.
20355
20356 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20357 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20358 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20359 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20360 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20361 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20362 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20363 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20364 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20365 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20366 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20367 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20368 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20369
20370 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20371 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20372 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20373 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20374 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20375 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020376 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020377 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20378
20379 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20380 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20381 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20382 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20383 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20384 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020385 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020386 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20387 occurs.
20388
20389 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20390 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20391 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20392 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20393 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20394 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20395 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20396 cookies" below for more details.
20397
20398 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20399 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20400 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20401 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20402 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20403 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20404 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20405 and cookies" below for more details.
20406
20407 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20408 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20409 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20410 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20411 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20412 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20413 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20414 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20415
20416
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204178.2.4. Custom log format
20418------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020419
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020420The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020421mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020422
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020423HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020424Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20425separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20426prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20427
20428Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20429variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020430("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020431
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020432If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020433as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020434less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20435the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20436
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020437Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20438"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20439delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20440preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020441
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020442Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20443'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20444https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20445such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20446
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020447Flags are :
20448 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020449 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020450 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20451 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020452
20453 Example:
20454
20455 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20456 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20457
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020458 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20459
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020460At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20461
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020462 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20463 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020464
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020465the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020466
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020467 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20468 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20469 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020470
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020471and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20472
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020473 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20474 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020475
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020476Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20477
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020478 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020479 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020480 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20481 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20482 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020483 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20484 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20485 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020486 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020487 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020488 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020489 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020490 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020491 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20492 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020493 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020494 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020495 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020496 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020497 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020498 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020499 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020500 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20501 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20502 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20503 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20504 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020505 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020506 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020507 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020508 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020509 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020510 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20511 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020512 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20513 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20514 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020515 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020516 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20517 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020518 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020519 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20520 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20521 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020522 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020523 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020524 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20525 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20526 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20527 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020528 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020529 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020530 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020531 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020532 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020533 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020534 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20535 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20536 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020537 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020538 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20539 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020540 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020541 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20542 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020543 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020544 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020545 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020546 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020547
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020548 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020549
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020550
205518.2.5. Error log format
20552-----------------------
20553
20554When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20555protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20556By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20557"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020558will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020559logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20560
20561The format looks like this :
20562
20563 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20564 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20565 Connection error during SSL handshake
20566
20567 Field Format Extract from the example above
20568 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20569 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20570 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20571 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20572 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20573
20574These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20575failures.
20576
20577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205788.3. Advanced logging options
20579-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020580
20581Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20582just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20583options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20584for more information about their usage.
20585
20586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20588------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020589
20590It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20591haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20592commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20593monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20594ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20595
20596 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20597 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20598 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20599 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20600
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020601 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20602 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020603
20604 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20605 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20606 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20607
20608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206098.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20610----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020611
20612The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20613what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20614or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020615"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020616just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20617log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20618after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20619is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20620with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20621with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20622
20623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206248.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20625------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020626
20627Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20628for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20629"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20630retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20631raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20632a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20633file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20634you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20635"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20636
20637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206388.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20639--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020640
20641Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20642multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20643them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20644"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20645logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20646error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20647and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20648too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20649useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20650alternative.
20651
20652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206538.4. Timing events
20654------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020655
20656Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20657reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20658the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20659frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020660mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20661addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20662
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020663Timings events in HTTP mode:
20664
20665 first request 2nd request
20666 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20667 t tr t tr ...
20668 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20669 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20670 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20671 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020672 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020673 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20674
20675Timings events in TCP mode:
20676
20677 TCP session
20678 |<----------------->|
20679 t t
20680 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20681 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20682 |<------ Tt ------->|
20683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020684 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020685 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020686 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20687 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20688 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020689 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020690 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20691 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20692 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20693 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020695 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20696 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20697 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020698 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20699 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20700 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20701 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20702 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20703 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020704
20705 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20706 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20707 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20708 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20709 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20710 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20711 request typed by hand during a test.
20712
20713 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20714 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020715 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020716 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20717 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20718 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20719 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020720
20721 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20722 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20723 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20724 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20725 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20726
20727 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20728 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20729 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20730 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20731 connection never established.
20732
20733 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20734 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20735 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20736 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20737 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20738 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20739 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20740 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20741 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20742 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20743 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20744
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020745 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20746 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20747 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20748 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20749 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20750 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20751
20752 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20753
20754 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20755 "Ta" can never be negative.
20756
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020757 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20758 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020759 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20760 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020761 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020762
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020763 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020764
20765 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020766 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20767 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020768
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020769 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20770 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20771 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20772 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20773 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20774 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20775 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20776 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20777
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020778These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20779protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20780that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020781due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20782"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20783that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020784
20785Most common cases :
20786
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020787 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20788 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20789 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20790 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20791 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20792 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20793 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20794 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20795 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20796 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20797 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020798 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020799
20800 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20801 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20802 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20803 of ms on remote networks.
20804
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020805 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20806 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20807 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020809 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20810 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20811 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20812 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20813 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20814 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20815 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20816 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20817 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020818
20819Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20820
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020821 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020822 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020823 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020825 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20827 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20828
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020829 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020830 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20831 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20832 flags.
20833
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020834 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20835 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020836 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20837 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20838 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20839 the client connection was maintained open.
20840
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020841 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020842 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020843 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020844 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20845
20846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208478.5. Session state at disconnection
20848-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020849
20850TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20851"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208522-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20853each of which has a special meaning :
20854
20855 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20856 session to terminate :
20857
20858 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20859
20860 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20861 server explicitly refused it.
20862
20863 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20864 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20865 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20866 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020867 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020868
20869 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20870 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020871
20872 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20873 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20874 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20875 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20876 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20877
20878 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20879 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20880 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20881 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20882 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20883
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020884 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20885 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20886
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020887 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20888 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20889 backup connections when going up.
20890
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020891 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20892
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020893 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20894 send or receive data.
20895
20896 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20897 send or receive data.
20898
20899 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20900 with nothing left in the buffers.
20901
20902 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20903
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020904 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020905 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20906
20907 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20908 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20909 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20910 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20911 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20912
20913 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20914 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20915
20916 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20917 server (HTTP only).
20918
20919 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20920
20921 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20922 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20923 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20924
20925 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20926 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20927 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20928
20929 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20930
20931 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20932 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20933
20934 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20935 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20936 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20937
20938 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20939 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020940 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20941 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020942
20943 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20944 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20945 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20946 another server.
20947
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020948 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020949 server.
20950
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020951 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20952 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20953 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20954 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20955
20956 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20957 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20958 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20959 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20960
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020961 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20962 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20963 "use-server" rule).
20964
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020965 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20966
20967 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20968 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20969
20970 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20971
20972 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20973 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20974 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20975
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020976 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20977 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020978 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020979 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20980 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020982 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20983
20984 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20985 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20986
20987 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20988
20989 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20990
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020991The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20992was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020993helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20994starvation, attacks, etc...
20995
20996The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20997alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20998easier finding and understanding.
20999
21000 Flags Reason
21001
21002 -- Normal termination.
21003
21004 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
21005 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
21006 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
21007 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21008
21009 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21010 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
21011 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21012 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
21013 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21014 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021015
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021016 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21017 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021018 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021019
21020 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21021 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21022 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21023
21024 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21025 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21026 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21027 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21028 the server takes too long to respond.
21029
21030 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21031 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21032 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21033 long a time to respond.
21034
21035 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21036 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21037 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
21038 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021039 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21040 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041
21042 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21043 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21044 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21045 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21046 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021047 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021048 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21049 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21050 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21051 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21052 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21053 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21054 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21055 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021056 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021057 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21058 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21059 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021060
21061 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21062 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021063 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21064 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21065 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21066 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021067
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021068 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21069 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021071 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021072 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21073 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021074 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021075 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21076 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21077
21078 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21079 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21080 503 or 504 here.
21081
21082 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21083 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21084 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21085 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21086 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21087
21088 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21089 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021090 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021091 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21092 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21093
21094 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21095 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21096 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21097 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21098 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21099 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21100 between haproxy and the server.
21101
21102 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21103 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21104 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21105 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21106 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21107 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21108 solution is to fix the application.
21109
21110 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21111 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21112 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21113 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21114 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21115 external attacks.
21116
21117 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021118 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021119 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21121 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21122
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021123 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21124 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21125 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021126 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021127 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021128
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021129 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21130 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21131 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21132 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021133 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21134 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21135 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21136 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21137 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021138
21139 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21140 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21141 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21142 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21143
21144 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21145 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21146 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21147 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21148
21149 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21150 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21151 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21152 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21153
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021154The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21155persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21156important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21157re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21158
21159 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21160
21161 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21162 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21163 set on a GET request.
21164
21165 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21166 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021167 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021168 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21169
21170 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21171 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21172 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21173
21174 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21175 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21176 already got a cookie.
21177
21178 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21179 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21180 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21181 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21182 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21183
21184 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21185 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21186 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21187
21188 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21189 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21190 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21191
21192 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21193 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21194
21195 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21196 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21197 then advertised in the response.
21198
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212008.6. Non-printable characters
21201-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021202
21203In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21204consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21205converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21206prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21207being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21208escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21209is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21210'}' when logging headers.
21211
21212Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21213issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21214containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21215
21216Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21217the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21218performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21219
21220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212218.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21222---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021223
21224Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21225achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021226section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021227cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21228the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21229the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021230locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21232user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21233a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21234wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21235
21236 Examples :
21237 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21238 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21239
21240 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21241 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21242
21243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212448.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21245---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246
21247Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21248proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21249the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21250server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21251
21252Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21253response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021254section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255
21256It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021257time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21258appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021259are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21260and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21261follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21262request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21263in the logs.
21264
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021265As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21266frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21267an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21268
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021269 Example :
21270 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21271 listen proxy-out
21272 mode http
21273 option httplog
21274 option logasap
21275 log global
21276 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21277
21278 # log the name of the virtual server
21279 capture request header Host len 20
21280
21281 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21282 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21283
21284 # log the beginning of the referrer
21285 capture request header Referer len 20
21286
21287 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21288 capture response header Server len 20
21289
21290 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21291 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021293 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021294 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21295
21296 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21297 capture response header Via len 20
21298
21299 # log the URL location during a redirection
21300 capture response header Location len 20
21301
21302 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21303 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21304 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21305 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21306 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21307
21308 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21309 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21310 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21311 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021312 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021313
21314 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21315 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21316 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21317 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21318 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021319 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021320
21321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213228.9. Examples of logs
21323---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021324
21325These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21326them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21327reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21328
21329 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21330 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21331 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21332
21333 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21334 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21335
21336 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21337 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21338 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21339
21340 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21341 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21342
21343 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21344 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21345 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21346
21347 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021348 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021349 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21350 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21351
21352 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21353 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21354 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21355
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021356 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21357 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21358 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21359 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21360 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21361 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021362
21363 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021364 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021365
21366 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21367 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21368 Nothing was sent to any server.
21369
21370 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21371 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21372
21373 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21374 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021375 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021376 send a 408 return code to the client.
21377
21378 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21379 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21380
21381 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21382 5 seconds ("c----").
21383
21384 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21385 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021386 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021387
21388 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021389 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021390 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21391 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21392 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21393 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21394 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021395
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021396
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200213979. Supported filters
21398--------------------
21399
21400Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21401accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21402unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21403
21404See also : "filter"
21405
214069.1. Trace
21407----------
21408
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021409filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021410
21411 Arguments:
21412 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21413 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21414
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021415 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021417 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021418 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21419 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21420 amount of the parsed data.
21421
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021422 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021423
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021424This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21425callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21426information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21427filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21428
21429Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21430tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21431a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21432
21433
214349.2. HTTP compression
21435---------------------
21436
21437filter compression
21438
21439The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21440keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021441when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21442fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21443done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21444explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21445filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21446listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21447order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021448
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021449See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21450 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021451
21452
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214539.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21454--------------------------------------------
21455
21456filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21457
21458 Arguments :
21459
21460 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21461 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21462 parsed.
21463
21464 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21465 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21466 part must be placed in its own scope.
21467
21468The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21469external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021470streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021471exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21472also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21473
21474SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21475the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21476
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021477For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021478"doc/SPOE.txt".
21479
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214809.4. Cache
21481----------
21482
21483filter cache <name>
21484
21485 Arguments :
21486
21487 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21488
21489The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21490"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021491cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021492other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21493case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21494is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21495filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021496listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21497order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021498
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021499See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21500 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21501
21502
215039.5. Fcgi-app
21504-------------
21505
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021506filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021507
21508 Arguments :
21509
21510 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21511
21512The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21513request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21514reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21515used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21516implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21517used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21518fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21519used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21520order.
21521
21522See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21523 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21524
21525
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215269.6. OpenTracing
21527----------------
21528
21529The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21530HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21531of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21532Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21533
21534This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21535
21536The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21537HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21538participates in the work of HAProxy.
21539
21540filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21541
21542 Arguments :
21543
21544 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21545 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21546 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21547 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21548 OpenTracing filters.
21549
21550 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21551 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21552 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21553 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21554 filter must have its own scope defined.
21555
21556More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021557of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021558
21559
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002156010. FastCGI applications
21561-------------------------
21562
21563HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21564feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21565the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21566FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21567servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21568FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21569backend.
21570
21571HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21572application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21573connection.
21574
2157510.1. Setup
21576-----------
21577
2157810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21579--------------------------
21580
21581fcgi-app <name>
21582 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21583 document root must be defined.
21584
21585acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21586 Declare or complete an access list.
21587
21588 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21589 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21590 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21591 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21592 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21593
21594docroot <path>
21595 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21596 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21597 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21598
21599index <script-name>
21600 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21601 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21602 is an optional setting.
21603
21604 Example :
21605 index index.php
21606
21607log-stderr global
21608log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021609 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021610 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21611
21612 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21613 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21614
21615pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21616 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21617 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21618 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21619
21620 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21621 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21622 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21623 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21624
21625 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21626 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21627
21628path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021629 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021630 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21631 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21632 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21633 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21634 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21635 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21636 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021637
21638 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021639 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021640 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21641 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21642 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21643 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021644
21645 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021646 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21647 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021648
21649option get-values
21650no option get-values
21651 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21652
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021653 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021654 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21655
21656 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21657 application will accept.
21658
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021659 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21660 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021661
21662 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021663 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021664 option is disabled.
21665
21666 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21667 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21668 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21669 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21670 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21671 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21672
21673option keep-conn
21674no option keep-conn
21675 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21676 sending a response.
21677
21678 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21679 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21680
21681option max-reqs <reqs>
21682 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21683 accept.
21684
21685 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21686 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21687 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21688 to 1.
21689
21690option mpxs-conns
21691no option mpxs-conns
21692 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21693
21694 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21695 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21696
21697set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21698 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21699 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21700 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21701 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21702
21703 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21704 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21705 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21706
21707 Example :
21708 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21709 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21710
21711 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21712
21713
2171410.1.2. Proxy section
21715---------------------
21716
21717use-fcgi-app <name>
21718 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21719
21720 Arguments :
21721 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21722
21723 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21724 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21725 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21726 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21727 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21728
21729 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21730 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21731 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21732 application are evaluated.
21733
21734
2173510.1.3. Example
21736---------------
21737
21738 frontend front-http
21739 mode http
21740 bind *:80
21741 bind *:
21742
21743 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21744 default_backend back-static
21745
21746 backend back-static
21747 mode http
21748 server www A.B.C.D:80
21749
21750 backend back-dynamic
21751 mode http
21752 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21753 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21754
21755 fcgi-app php-fpm
21756 log-stderr global
21757 option keep-conn
21758
21759 docroot /var/www/my-app
21760 index index.php
21761 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21762
21763
2176410.2. Default parameters
21765------------------------
21766
21767A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21768the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021769script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021770applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21771
21772 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21773 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21774 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21775 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21776 | | |
21777 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21778 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21779 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21780 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21781 | | application. |
21782 | | |
21783 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21784 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21785 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21786 | | |
21787 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21788 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21789 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21790 | | the application's configuration. |
21791 | | |
21792 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21793 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21794 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21795 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21796 | | |
21797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21798 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21799 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21800 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21801 | | be defined. |
21802 | | |
21803 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21804 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21805 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21806 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21807 | | is not set too. |
21808 | | |
21809 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21810 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21811 | | set. |
21812 | | |
21813 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21814 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21815 | | the request. |
21816 | | |
21817 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21818 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21819 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21820 | | |
21821 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21822 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21823 | | script to process the request. |
21824 | | |
21825 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21826 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21827 | | |
21828 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21829 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21830 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21831 | | |
21832 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21833 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21834 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21835 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21836 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21837 | | |
21838 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21839 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21840 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21841 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21842 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21843 | | side. |
21844 | | |
21845 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21846 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21847 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21848 | | connected to. |
21849 | | |
21850 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21851 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21852 | | |
21853 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21854 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21855 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21856 | | |
21857 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21858
21859
2186010.3. Limitations
21861------------------
21862
21863The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21864way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21865during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21866establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21867application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21868or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21869message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21870these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21871and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21872
21873Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21874request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21875requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21876
21877About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21878into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21879fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21880"http-request" ones.
21881
21882Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21883FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21884processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21885must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21886here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021887
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021888
2188911. Address formats
21890-------------------
21891
21892Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21893address.
21894
21895This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21896The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21897of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21898equivalent is '::'.
21899
21900Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21901is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21902
21903This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21904family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21905
21906Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21907configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21908use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21909'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21910
21911Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21912socket type and the transport method.
21913
21914
2191511.1 Address family prefixes
21916----------------------------
21917
21918'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21919
21920'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21921 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21922 listening.
21923
21924'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21925 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21926 on the statement using this address, a port or
21927 a port range may or must be specified.
21928
21929'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21930 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21931 using this address, a port or a port range
21932 may or must be specified.
21933
21934'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21935 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21936 using this address, a port or a port range
21937 may or must be specified.
21938
21939'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21940 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21941 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21942 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21943 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21944 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21945
21946'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21947 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21948 start by slash '/'.
21949
21950
2195111.2 Socket type prefixes
21952-------------------------
21953
21954Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21955type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21956this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21957This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21958but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21959
21960Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21961instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21962
21963If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21964they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21965report this to the maintainers.
21966
21967'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21968 to "stream"
21969
21970'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21971 to "datagram".
21972
21973
2197411.3 Protocol prefixes
21975----------------------
21976
21977'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21978 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21979 socket type and transport method is forced to
21980 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21981 this address, a port or a port range can or
21982 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21983 of 'stream+ip@'.
21984
21985'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21986 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21987 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21988 statement using this address, a port or port
21989 range can or must be specified.
21990 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21991
21992'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21993 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21994 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21995 statement using this address, a port or port
21996 range can or must be specified.
21997 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21998
21999'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22000 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22001 socket type and transport method is forced to
22002 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22003 this address, a port or a port range can or
22004 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22005 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22006
22007'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22008 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22009 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22010 the statement using this address, a port or
22011 port range can or must be specified.
22012 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22013
22014'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22015 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22016 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22017 the statement using this address, a port or
22018 port range can or must be specified.
22019 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22020
22021'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22022 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22023 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22024
22025'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22026 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22027 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22028
22029In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22030QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022032/*
22033 * Local variables:
22034 * fill-column: 79
22035 * End:
22036 */